CODE 01/01/17/2000
99011M66R00-74E
Service Division
MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
Palam Gurgaon Road, Gurgaon - 122 015 (Haryana)
www.marutisuzuki.com
OWNER’S MANUAL & SERVICE BOOKLET
• Keep With Vehicle At All Times • Contains Important Information On Safety, Operation & Maintenance
Part No. 99011M66R00-74E
January, 2017
ENG
This Owner Manual & Service Booklet applies to the IGNIS series
produced by MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
January, 2017
Part No. 99011M66R00-74E
For 24 X 7 assistance, contact Toll Free number 1800 200 6392#
© COPYRIGHT MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED 2017
Note: The illustrated model is one of the IGNIS Series.
(NEXA)
Celerio
Pankaj Narula
Sr. Advisor (Service)
Dear Sir/Madam,
Thank you for choosing a Maruti Suzuki vehicle.
I hope our dealership team took good care while delivering the vehicle to you.
Celerio
Your vehicle is equipped with state-of-the-art technologies. To get the best performance from
your vehicle (and ensure it is trouble-free), kindly get your vehicle serviced periodically, as per
the maintenance schedule in your Owner's Manual. Please make sure the service is done at a
Maruti Suzuki authorized workshop for best results.
For any accessories that you wish to fit on to your vehicle, please contact any of our authorized
dealers for assistance. Kindly appreciate that any tampering of wiring harness to fit
accessories may cause the vehicle to malfunction.
Thank you once again for choosing a Maruti Suzuki vehicle.
I wish you many years of safe and happy driving.
Yours sincerely
Celerio
MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
Palam Gurgaon Road,
Gurgaon-122015
www.marutisuzuki.com
(Pankaj Narula)
“WARNING”
Vehicle may break-down, meet with an
accident or catch fire due to
1. Installation of
- High wattage bulbs
- Non genuine lamps / horns
- Modified suspension / wheels
- Non genuine parts / accessories etc.
2. Retrofitment of LPG / CNG fuel systems/kits.
3. Usage of domestic LPG.
4. Short circuiting due to tampering of wiring harness.
CAUTION: DO NOT STORE OR CARRY INFLAMMABLE MATERIALS IN THE VEHICLE.
Avoid driving into or starting the vehicle in a
heavily water logged area. Vehicle may breakdown or engine may fail due to
1. Water entry into the engine.
2. Short circuiting of the electrical systems.
If the vehicle is stuck in deep water, do not
start / crank the vehicle until the level of water
drops below the level of exhaust pipe.
NOTE:
IF THE VEHICLE IS SUBMERGED IN WATER, REPORT
AUTHORIZED WORKSHOP.
TO
THE
NEAREST
“CAUTION”
1. Retro-fitment of LPG / CNG kit may deteriorate vehicle performance, reduce engine & engine
related component’s life and also warranty will be null and void for such vehicles.
2. Do not use domestic LPG/LPG cylinder for your factory fitted LPG vehicles.
3. Usage of domestic LPG for running vehicles is prohibited as per law.
4. Do not remove company fitted LPG/CNG kit to install some other kit. It may affect vehicle
performance and may cause fire.
5. Drive slowly on wet roads. Tires may slip while braking at higher speeds due to aquaplaning.
(reduced contact area between tire and road due to presence of water)
6. Do not leave engine running in garages or confined areas, with passengers inside. This may result in
accumulation of carbon-monoxide in cabin and may lead to suffocation or breathing problems.
7. Do not park vehicle on dry leaves or grass. This may lead to fire due to hot catalytic converter,
igniting the dry leaves/grass.
8. If the vehicle is equipped with CNG/LPG, ensure availability of fire extinguisher in the vehicle all the time.
9. Always wear seat belt at all the times.
10. Do not use mobile phone while driving.
11. Avoid Smoking in the car, live bud thrown in car may cause fire.
12. Do not put any body part under the vehicle when it is supported on a Jack.
13. Do not use non-genuine accessories in your vehicle.
14. Do not fit accessories from unauthorized workshops/sources.
15. Usage of non-approved electrical accessories in your vehicle may result in spark, fire or personal
injury.
FOREWORD
This manual is an essential part of your
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle
when resold or otherwise transferred to a
new owner or operator. Please read this
manual carefully before operating your
new MARUTI SUZUKI and review the
manual from time to time. It contains
important information on safety, operation
and maintenance. You are invited to avail
the three Free Inspection Services as
described in the manual. Three free
inspection coupons are attached to this
manual. Please show this manual to your
dealer while you take your MARUTI
SUZUKI for any Service.
To prolong the life of your vehicle and
reduce maintenance cost, the periodic
maintenance must be carried out according to “PERIODIC MAINTENANCE
SCHEDULE” described in “INSPECTION
AND MAINTENANCE” section of this manual. It is essential for preventing trouble
and accidents to ensure your satisfaction
and safety.
Daily inspection and care as per “DAILY
INSPECTION CHECKLIST” described in
the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
section of this manual is essential for prolonging the life of the vehicle and for safe
driving.
MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED believes
in conservation and protection of Earth’s
natural resources.
To that end, we encourage every vehicle
owner to recycle, trade-in or properly dispose of, as appropriate, used Engine Oil,
coolant and other fluids, batteries and
tyres etc.
MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
All information in this manual is based
on the latest product information available at the time of publication. Due to
improvements or other changes, there
may be discrepancies between information in this manual and your vehicle.
MARUTI
SUZUKI
INDIA
LIMITED
reserves the right to make production
changes at any time, without notice and
without incurring any obligation to
make the same or similar changes to
vehicles previously built or sold.
This vehicle may not comply with standards or regulations of other countries.
Before attempting to register this vehicle in any other country, check all applicable regulations and make any necessary modifications.
1
68PH0-74E
IMPORTANT
MODIFICATION
ING
WARNING/
CAUTION/NOTICE/
NOTE
Please read this manual and follow its
instructions carefully. To emphasize special information, the symbol and the words
WARNING, CAUTION, NOTICE and
NOTE have special meanings. Pay particular attention to messages highlighted by
these signal words:
WARNING
WARNING
Indicates a potential hazard that
could result in death or serious
injury.
CAUTION
Indicates a potential hazard that
could result in minor or moderate
injury.
NOTICE
Indicates a potential hazard that
could result in vehicle damage.
NOTE:
Indicates special information to make
maintenance easier or instructions clearer.
WARN-
75F135
The circle with a slash in this manual
means “Don’t do this” or “Don’t let this happen”.
Do not modify your vehicle. Modification could adversely affect safety,
handling, performance, or durability
and may violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from
modification may not be covered
under warranty.
NOTICE
Improper installation of mobile communication equipment such as cellular telephones, CB (Citizen’s Band)
radios or any other wireless transmitters may cause electronic interference with your vehicle’s ignition
system, resulting in vehicle performance problems. Consult your MARUTI SUZUKI dealer or qualified
service technician for advice.
NOTICE
Severe damage may be caused by
the use of either poor quality fuel
and/or lubricants not recommended
by MARUTI SUZUKI.
2
68PH0-74E
WARRANTY POLICY
(4) Limitation:
This warranty shall not apply to:
Maruti Suzuki India Limited (hereinafter called “Maruti Suzuki”),
warrants that each new Maruti Suzuki vehicle distributed in India
by Maruti Suzuki and sold by an authorised Maruti Suzuki NEXA
dealer will be free, under normal use and service, from any
defects in material and workmanship at the time of manufacture
SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING TERMS AND CONDITIONS:
(a)
(b)
(1) Qualification:
To qualify for this warranty:
The Maruti Suzuki vehicle must be delivered by authorised Maruti
Suzuki NEXA dealer and serviced by authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
(c)
(d)
(2) Term:
(e)
The term of the warranty shall be twenty-four (24) months or
40,000 kilometers (whichever occurs first) from the date of
invoice to the first owner.
(3) Maruti Suzuki Warranty Obligation:
If any defect(s) should be found in a Maruti Suzuki vehicle within
the term stipulated above, Maruti Suzuki’s only obligation is to
repair or replace at its sole discretion any part shown to be defective, with a new part or the equivalent at no cost to the owner for
parts or labour, when Maruti Suzuki acknowledges that such a
defect is attributable to faulty material or workmanship at the time
of manufacture. The owner is responsible for any repair or replacements which are not covered by this warranty.
(f)
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Normal maintenance service required other than the three
free services, including without limitation, oil and fluid
changes, headlight aiming, fastener retightening, wheel balancing, wheel alignment and tyre rotation, cleaning of injectors, ignition timing, clutch and valve clearance.
The replacement of normal wear parts including without limitation, bulbs, tyres and tubes, spark plugs, belts, hoses, filters, wiper blades, brushes, contact points, fuses, clutch
disc, brake shoes, brake pads, cable and all rubber parts
(except oil seal and glass run).
Any vehicle which has been used for competition or racing.
Any repairs or replacement required as a result of accidents
or collision.
Any defects caused by misuse, negligence, abnormal use or
insufficient care.
Any vehicle which has been modified or altered, including
without limitation, the installation of performance accessories.
Any vehicle on which parts or accessories not approved by
Maruti Suzuki have been used.
Any vehicle which has not been operated in accordance with
the operating instructions in this Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet.
Any vehicle which has not received, during the warranty term,
the service inspections prescribed in this Owner’s Manual
and Service Booklet.
Any vehicle which has been assembled, disassembled,
adjusted or repaired by other than authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
Any vehicle which has been used for purposes other than
what it was designed for.
3
68PH0-74E
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
Any damage or deterioration caused by industrial pollution
and bird droppings.
Insignificant defects which do not affect the function of the
vehicle including without limitation, sound, vibration and fluid
seep.
Any natural wear and tear including without limitation, ageing
etc.
Installation and usage of domestic LPG gas/LPG Cylinder.
V-belts, hoses and gas leaks.
Any vehicle retrofitted with LPG/CNG kits.
(5) Extent of Warranty:
This warranty is the entire written warranty given by Maruti Suzuki
for Maruti Suzuki vehicles and no dealer or its or his agent or
employee is authorised to extend or enlarge this warranty and no
dealer or its or his agent or employee is authorised to make any
oral warranty on Maruti Suzuki’s behalf.
Maruti Suzuki reserves the right to add any improvements or
change the design of any model at any time with no obligation to
make the same changes on units previously sold.
(6) Warranty Service:
– Make certain that the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
has certified the work on the “Maintenance Service Record”
page in the “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet and
– Present the Maruti Suzuki “Owner’s Manual and Service
Booklet to the authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop whenever
requesting service inspections or warranty service.
If the “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet” should be lost or
destroyed the owner should consult the authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop from whom the vehicle was purchased for instructions
concerning replacement of the “Owner’s Manual and Service
Booklet”.
(8) Disclaimer of Consequential Damage:
Maruti Suzuki assumes no responsibility for loss of vehicle, loss of
time, inconvenience or any other indirect incidental or consequential damage resulting from the vehicle not being available to the
owner because of any defect covered by this warranty.
(9) Change of Owner
Even if ownership of the vehicle changes, the remaining warranty
period is effective for the new owner.
To obtain warranty service, the complete vehicle must be presented at the owner’s expenses to any authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
(7) Owner’s Warranty Responsibilities:
It is responsibility of each owner to:
– Have performed, at his own expenses, by an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop all the service inspections specified
in the Maruti Suzuki “Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet
and maintain adequate proof that such service inspections
have been performed.
4
68PH0-74E
EMISSION WARRANTY POLICY
Maruti Suzuki offers the Emission Warranty on all Maruti Suzuki
vehicles (apart from the Regular Warranty and will run parallel to
the regular product warranty) only in four metropolitan cities (New
Delhi, Kolkata, Mumbai and Chennai) with effect from July 1st,
2001.
Terms:
The Emission Warranty will be applicable for 80,000 kms or 3
years (Whichever comes earlier) from the date of invoice to the
first owner. The remaining warranty terms will be valid in case of
any change in ownership provided the production of all valid documents.
Conditions:
1. Under Emission Warranty, Warranty claims will be admitted for
a prima-facie examination, in case vehicle fails to meet the
Emission Standard as specified in sub rule (2) of rule no. 115
of Central Motor Vehicles Rules (CMVR), 1989.
2. The warranty claims will only be accepted after examination
carried out by Maruti Suzuki or authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop which leads to firm conclusions that the
a) Original settings have not been tampered in any case.
b) Part (as given in Annexure - A) has a manufacturing defect.
c) Vehicle is unable to meet the Emission Standards (as given
in 1.), inspite of the vehicle having been maintained and
used in accordance with the instructions as specified in
Owner’s Manual and Service Booklet and the used fuel and
different oils (Engine oil, Transmission oil, Brake oil etc.) are
also as per specification.
3. The method of examination for deciding the warranty of the
parts will be at the sole discretion of Maruti Suzuki and authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop and results of the examination
will be final and binding. If after examination, the warrantable
condition is not established, Maruti Suzuki and authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop has the right to charge all, or part of
the cost of such examination.
4. Under Emission Warranty, the parts (as given in Annexure - A)
will be changed free of cost, but the consumables will be
charged as per actual.
5. If the part covered under Emission Warranty or the associated
parts, are not independently replaceable, on account of these
being integral parts of a complete assembly, Maruti Suzuki and
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop will have the sole discretion to replace either the entire assembly or by using some of
the parts of the system through suitable repairs or modifications.
6. Any consequential repairs or replacement of parts which may
be found necessary to establish compliance of Emission Warranty, will not be considered under warranty, unless the same is
under product warranty. The consumable will be charged as
per actual under such repair or replacement.
7. Maruti Suzuki will not be responsible for the cost of transportation of the vehicle to the nearest authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop or any loss due to non-availability of the vehicle
during the period of lodging of a warranty claim and examination and/or repair by Maruti Suzuki workshop.
8. Maruti Suzuki will not be responsible for any penalty that may
be charged by statutory authorities on account of failure to
comply with the EMISSION STANDARDS.
9. Emission Warranty will not be affected by the change of owner,
provided all the documents are available.
5
68PH0-74E
10. All maintenance actions (as specified in the Owner’s Manual
and Service Booklet) need to be followed and recorded in the
manual for emission warranty.
11. The customer needs to produce the PUC (Pollution Under
Control) certificate valid for the period preceding the test
during which the failure is discovered. The receipts (for the
maintenance of the vehicle as per specification in Owner’s
Manual and Service Booklet from the date of original purchase of the vehicle) will also be required.
Conditions under which the Emission Warranty is not
APPLICABLE
1. In the absence of valid PUC certificate.
2. Vehicle not serviced from authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
as per the schedule specified in the Owner’s Manual.
3. Vehicle subjected to abnormal use (accident, motor race, rallies or for the purpose of establishing the records etc).
4. Use of non MGP (Maruti Genuine Part).
5. Vehicle that has been tampered with.
6. Tampering with odometer so that the actual kilometer reading
cannot be determined.
7. Use of adulterated fuel and/or unspecified oils (Engine oil,
Transmission oil and Brake oil etc).
Annexure - A
List of parts covered under Emission Warranty
1. Fuel Injection Assembly, Pressure Regulator, Throttle Body
Assembly.
2. Electronic Control Module (ECM).
3. Intake Manifold.
4. EGR valve.
5. Ignition Coil.
6. Canister Assembly.
7. Vapour Liquid Seperator.
8. Fuel Tank and Filler Cap.
9. PCV (Positive Crankcase Ventilation) Valve.
10. Oil Filler Cap.
11. Catalytic Convertor.
12. Exhaust Manifold.
13. All Fuel Injection System related Sensors.
14. High Pressure Fuel Pump.
15. Glow Plug.
16. Glow Plug Controller.
6
68PH0-74E
TABLE OF CONTENTS
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
1
BEFORE DRIVING
2
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
3
DRIVING TIPS
4
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
5
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
6
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
7
EMERGENCY SERVICE
8
APPEARANCE CARE
9
GENERAL INFORMATION
10
SPECIFICATIONS
11
66RH0-74E
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
1
Fuel recommendation ......................................................... 1-1
65D394
66RH0-74E
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
Fuel Recommendation
Petrol Engine
You must use unleaded petrol with an
octane number (RON) of 91 or higher.
Petrol/Ethanol blends
Blends of unleaded petrol and ethanol
(grain alcohol), also known as gasohol, are
commercially available in some areas.
Blends of this type may be used in your
vehicle if they are no more than 10% ethanol. Make sure this petrol-ethanol blend
has octane ratings no lower than those
recommended for petrol.
Petrol/Methanol blends
Blends of unleaded petrol and methanol
(wood alcohol) are also commercially
available in some areas. DO NOT USE
fuels containing more than 5% methanol
under any circumstances. Fuel system
damage or vehicle performance problems
resulting from the use of such fuels are not
the responsibility of MARUTI SUZUKI and
may not be covered under the New Vehicle
Warranty.
Fuels containing 5% or less methanol may
be suitable for use in your vehicle if they
contain cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors.
NOTE:
If you are not satisfied with the driveability
or fuel economy of your vehicle when you
are using a petrol/alcohol blend, you
should switch back to unleaded petrol containing no alcohol.
NOTICE
The fuel tank has an air space to
allow for fuel expansion in hot
weather. If you continue to add fuel
after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off or an initial blowback
occurs, the air chamber will become
full. Exposure to heat when fully
fuelled in this manner will result in
leakage due to fuel expansion. To
prevent such fuel leakage, stop filling
after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off, or when using an alternative non-automatic system, initial
vent blowback occurs.
NOTICE
Be careful not to spill fuel containing
alcohol while refueling. If fuel is
spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up
immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is
not covered under the New Vehicle
Warranty.
1-1
66RH0-74E
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
Diesel Engine
You must use diesel fuel with Cetane Number (CN) higher than 51 and sulfur content
less than 350 ppm (parts per million).
MARUTI SUZUKI recommends to use the
diesel fuel conformable to EN590. Do not
use marine diesel fuel, heating oils and so
forth.
NOTICE
The fuel tank has an air space to
allow for fuel expansion in hot
weather. If you continue to add fuel
after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off or an initial blowback
occurs, the air chamber will become
full. Exposure to heat when fully
fueled in this manner will result in
leakage due to fuel expansion. To
prevent such fuel leakage, stop filling
after the filler nozzle has automatically shut off, or when using an alternative non-automatic system, initial
vent blowback occurs.
NOTICE
Be careful not to spill fuel containing
alcohol while refueling. If fuel is
spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up
immediately. Fuels containing alcohol can cause paint damage, which is
not covered under the New Vehicle
Warranty.
1-2
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
BEFORE DRIVING
60G404
Keys ...................................................................................... 2-1
Door locks ............................................................................ 2-2 2
Keyless push start system remote controller /
Keyless entry system transmitter (if equipped) ............... 2-6
Security system (if equipped) ............................................ 2-15
Windows .............................................................................. 2-18
Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-21
Front seats ........................................................................... 2-22
Rear seats ............................................................................ 2-24
Seat belts and child restraint systems .............................. 2-26
Supplemental restraint system (air bags) ......................... 2-42
Instrument cluster ............................................................... 2-49
Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-50
Tachometer (if equipped) ................................................... 2-50
Fuel gauge ........................................................................... 2-51
Brightness control .............................................................. 2-51
Information display
(instrument cluster with tachometer) ................................ 2-53
Information display
(instrument cluster without tachometer) .......................... 2-66
Warning and indicator lights .............................................. 2-72
Lighting control lever ......................................................... 2-78
Front fog light switch (if equipped) ................................... 2-79
Headlight leveling switch ................................................... 2-80
Turn signal control lever .................................................... 2-80
Hazard warning switch ....................................................... 2-81
Windshield wiper and washer lever .................................. 2-82
Tilt steering lock lever ........................................................ 2-84
Horn ...................................................................................... 2-84
Heated rear window switch (if equipped) ......................... 2-85
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Keys
Immobilizer system
EXAMPLE
54G489
Your vehicle comes with a pair of keys.
The key(s) may or may not be equipped
with a transmitter depending on model
variant. Keep the spare key in a safe
place. One key can open all of the locks on
the vehicle.
The key identification number is stamped
on a metal tag provided with the keys or on
the keys. Keep the tag (if equipped) in a
safe place. If you lose your keys, you will
need this number to have new keys made.
Write the number below for your future reference.
KEY NUMBER:
This system is designed to help prevent
vehicle theft by electronically disabling the
engine starting system.
The engine can be started only with your
vehicle’s original immobilizer ignition key
or keyless push start system remote controller, which has an electronic identification code programmed into it. The key or
remote controller communicates the identification code to the vehicle when the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or the
engine switch is pressed to change the
ignition mode to “ON”. If you need to make
spare keys or remote controllers, see your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. The
vehicle must be programmed with the correct identification code for the spare. A key
made by an ordinary locksmith will not
work.
80JM122
If the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light blinks or comes on when
the ignition switch is in “ON” position or the
ignition mode is “ON”, the engine will not
start.
NOTE:
If the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light blinks or comes on, a
message may be shown on the information
display.
For vehicles without a keyless push
start system
If this light blinks or comes on, turn the
ignition switch to “LOCK” position, and
then turn it back to “ON” position.
If the light still blinks or comes on after the
ignition switch is turned back to “ON” position, there may be something wrong with
your key or with the immobilizer system.
Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to have the system inspected.
For vehicles with a keyless push start
system
If this light blinks or comes on, change the
ignition mode to LOCK (OFF), and then
change it back to “ON”. Also refer to “If the
master warning indicator light blinks or
comes on and the engine cannot be
started” in “Starting the engine (vehicle
with keyless push start system)” in the
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
If the light still blinks or comes on after the
ignition mode is changed back to “ON”,
there may be something wrong with your
key or with the immobilizer system. Ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the system inspected.
2-1
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
The immobilizer/keyless push start system
warning light may also blinks if the remote
controller is not in the vehicle when you
close the door or attempt to start the
engine.
NOTE:
• If you lose your immobilizer ignition key
or remote controller, ask your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible to deactivate the lost one, and to
make a new key or remote controller.
• If you own other vehicles with immobilizer keys, keep those keys away from
the ignition switch or the engine switch
when using your vehicle or the engine
may not be started because they may
interfere with your vehicle’s immobilizer
system.
• If you attach any metal objects to the
immobilizer key or remote controller, it
may not start the engine.
NOTICE
The immobilizer key and remote controller are sensitive electronic instruments. To avoid damaging them:
• Do not expose them to impacts,
moisture or high temperature such
as on the dashboard under direct
sunlight.
• Keep them away from magnetic
objects.
Ignition key reminder (if equipped)
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the
ignition switch when the driver’s door is
opened.
Door locks
Side door locks
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
68PH00201
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
UNLOCK
LOCK
Front
Rear
To lock a driver’s door from outside the
vehicle:
• Insert a key and turn the top of the key
toward the front of the vehicle, or
• Turn the lock knob forward, then pull and
hold the door handle as you close the
door.
2-2
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
To unlock a driver’s door from outside the
vehicle, insert the key and turn the top of
the key toward the rear of the vehicle.
Central door locking system
NOTE:
You can switch the function that unlocks all
doors from requiring two turns to requiring
one turn, and vice versa, via the information display setting mode. For details on
how to use the information display, refer to
“Information display” in this section.
EXAMPLE
(1)
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
(3)
(2)
To unlock the driver’s door only, insert the
key in that door lock and turn the top of the
key toward the rear of the vehicle once.
EXAMPLE
(4)
(1)
(2)
76MH0A002
66RH010
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
LOCK
UNLOCK
Front
Rear
To lock a door from the inside of the vehicle, turn the lock knob forward. Turn the
lock knob backward to unlock the door.
You can lock and unlock all doors (including the tailgate) simultaneously by using
the key in the driver’s door lock.
To lock a rear door from the outside of the
vehicle, turn the lock knob forward and
close the door. You do not need to pull and
hold the door handle as you close the door.
To lock all doors simultaneously, insert the
key in the driver’s door lock and turn the
top of the key toward the front of the vehicle once.
NOTE:
Hold the door handle when you close a
locked front door, or the door will not
remain locked.
To unlock all doors simultaneously, insert
the key in the driver’s door lock and turn
the top of the key toward the rear of the
vehicle twice.
66RH011
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
You can also lock or unlock all doors from
inside by depressing the front or rear of the
switch, respectively on the driver side.
2-3
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
• If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless entry system or keyless push start
system, you can also lock or unlock all
doors by operating the transmitter or
remote controller. Refer to “Keyless
push start system remote controller /
Keyless entry system transmitter” in this
section.
• If your vehicle is equipped with the keyless push start system, you can also lock
or unlock all doors by pushing the
request switch. Refer to “Keyless push
start system remote controller / Keyless
entry system transmitter” in this section.
Child-proof locks (rear door)
Tailgate
WARNING
EXAMPLE
(2)
Always make sure that the tailgate is
closed and latched securely. Completely closing the tailgate helps prevent occupants from being thrown
from the vehicle in the event of an
accident. Completely closing it also
helps keep exhaust gases from entering the vehicle.
(1)
Type A
75RM037
NOTE:
• All doors are automatically unlocked
when you change the ignition mode to
LOCK (OFF) or turn the ignition switch to
the “LOCK” position and pull out the key.
• All doors are automatically locked for
safety when the vehicle speed reaches
15 km/h.
• You can change the automatic locking or
unlocking function mentioned above via
the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information
display” in this section.
EXAMPLE
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
Each of the rear doors is equipped with a
child-proof lock which can be used to help
prevent unwanted opening of the door
from inside the vehicle. When the lock
lever is in LOCK position (1), the rear door
can only be opened from outside. When
the lock lever is in UNLOCK position (2),
the rear door can be opened from inside or
outside.
WARNING
Place the child-proof lock in LOCK
position whenever children are
seated in the rear.
(1)
66RH012
You can lock and unlock the tailgate by
using the key in the driver’s door lock.
2-4
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
To open the tailgate, pull up the tailgate
handle (1) and lift the tailgate.
If you cannot unlock the tailgate by using
the key in the driver’s door lock due to a
discharged battery or malfunction, follow
the procedure below to unlatch the tailgate
from inside the vehicle.
1) Remove the luggage compartment
cover (if equipped) and fold the rear
seat forward for easier access. Refer to
“Folding rear seats” section for details
on how to fold the rear seat forward.
If the tailgate cannot be unlocked, have the
vehicle inspected by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
EXAMPLE
Type B
EXAMPLE
(1)
(3)
(3)
EXAMPLE
65P30080
3) Move the lever (3) in arrow direction by
using a flat blade screwdriver to unlock
the tailgate.
EXAMPLE
(2)
(2)
66RH096
You can lock or unlock the tailgate by using
the key in the tailgate lock (1).
To open the tailgate, pull up the tailgate
handle (2) and lift the tailgate.
62R0366
2) Open the cover (2) in the lock mechanism of the tailgate.
NOTE:
Be careful not to lose the cover (2)
because it is small and detachable.
NOTICE
(4)
66RH095
4) From outside the vehicle, pull up the
tailgate handle (4) and lift the tailgate.
Do not use key to lift up the tailgate,
or the key may break off in the lock.
2-5
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Keyless push start system
remote controller /
Keyless entry system
transmitter (if equipped)
Type A
Type B
EXAMPLE
82PH02035
Your vehicle is equipped with either a keyless push start system remote controller
(Type A) or a keyless entry system transmitter (Type B). The remote controller has
a keyless entry system and a keyless push
start system. The transmitter has only a
keyless entry system. For details, refer to
the following explanations.
WARNING
Radio waves from the keyless push
start system antenna(s) may interfere
with operation of electrical medical
equipment such as pacemakers. Failure to take the precautions listed
below can increase the risk of severe
injury or death due to radio wave
interference.
• Anyone who uses electrical medical equipment such as a pacemaker should consult the medical
equipment supplier or their medical
advisor about whether radio waves
from the antenna(s) can interfere
with the medical equipment.
• If radio wave interference is a concern, have the function of the
antenna(s) disabled by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Keyless push start system remote
controller (Type A)
The remote controller enables the following operations:
• You can lock or unlock the doors by
operating LOCK/UNLOCK buttons on
the remote controller. Refer to the explanation in this section.
• You can lock or unlock the doors by
pushing the request switch. For details,
refer to the explanation in this section.
• You can start the engine without using
an ignition key. For details, refer to
“Engine switch” in the “OPERATING
YOUR VEHICLE” section.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
82PH02034
(1) LOCK button
(2) UNLOCK button
2-6
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
You can lock or unlock all doors (including
the tailgate) simultaneously by operating
the remote controller near the vehicle.
Central door locking system
• To lock all doors, push LOCK button (1)
once.
• To unlock only the driver’s door, push
UNLOCK button (2) once.
• To unlock other doors, push UNLOCK
button (2) once again.
NOTE:
You can switch the function that unlocks all
doors from requiring two pushes to requiring one push, and vice versa, via the information display setting mode. For details on
how to use the information display, refer to
“Information display” in this section.
The turn signal lights will flash once and
the siren will sound once when the doors
are locked.
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice and
the siren will sound twice.
• If the interior light switch is in DOOR
position, the interior light will turn on for
about 15 seconds and then fade out. If
you press the engine switch during this
time, the light will start to fade out immediately.
Make sure that the doors are locked after
you operate LOCK button (1).
If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after UNLOCK button (2) is operated,
the doors will automatically lock again.
NOTE:
• If you lock the doors using the remote
controller when the engine hood is open,
the siren will sound 3 times to remind
you.
• If the security system was triggered due
to an unauthorized entry into the vehicle
and then you unlock the doors using the
remote controller, the siren will sound 4
times to remind you. If this happens,
check whether your vehicle has been
broken into while you were away from it.
• Once you push both of the LOCK button
(1) and UNLOCK button (2), then you
push one of the buttons within 5 seconds, the siren will not sound. However,
if you push one of the buttons twice or
more within 5 seconds, or push one of
the buttons 5 seconds later, the siren will
sound.
• You can set whether the siren sounds
when locking or unlocking the doors via
the setting mode of the information display. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information
display” in this section.
NOTE:
• The maximum operating distance of the
remote controller is about 5 m (16 ft.),
but this can vary depending on the surroundings, especially near other transmitting devices such as radio towers or
CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.
• The door locks cannot be operated with
the remote controller if the ignition mode
is in any other mode than LOCK (OFF).
• If any door is open, you cannot lock the
door by operating the remote controller,
however unlock the door.
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,
ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible for replacement. Have your dealer program the
new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is
erased.
2-7
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Panic alarm function
This function is to get the attention of others.
Push both of the LOCK button (1) and
UNLOCK button (2) for more than 3 seconds. The turn signal lights will blink for
about 27.5 seconds. Also, the siren will
sound for about 27.5 seconds at the same
time.
To cancel the panic alarm, press any button (LOCK or UNLOCK).
You can also cancel the panic alarm in any
of the following operations.
• Press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON.
• Bring the remote controller with you and
press the request switch.
NOTE:
The panic alarm function will not activate
when the ignition mode is ACC or ON.
Keyless unlocking/locking using the
request switches
EXAMPLE
To unlock a door or all doors:
• Push one of the request switches once
to unlock only one door.
• Push one of the request switches twice
to unlock all doors.
NOTE:
You can switch the function that unlocks all
doors from requiring two pushes to requiring one push, and vice versa, via the information display setting mode. For details on
how to use the information display, refer to
“Information display” in this section.
(1)
(1)
66RH013
When the remote controller is within the
operating range described in this section,
you can lock or unlock the doors (including
the tailgate) by pushing the request switch
(1) on the driver’s door handle, front passenger’s door handle or tailgate.
When all doors are unlocked:
• To lock all doors, push one of the
request switches once.
The turn signal lights will flash once and
the siren will sound once when the doors
are locked.
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice and
the siren will sound twice.
• If the interior light switch is in DOOR
position, the interior light will turn on for
about 15 seconds and then fade out. If
you press the engine switch during this
time, the light will start to fade out immediately.
Make sure that the doors are locked after
you operate the request switch to lock the
doors.
NOTE:
• The door locks cannot be operated by
the request switch under the following
conditions:
– If any door is open or is not completely
closed.
– If the ignition mode is in any other
mode than LOCK (OFF).
2-8
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
• If no doors are opened within about 30
seconds after unlocking the doors by
pushing the request switch, the doors
will be locked again automatically.
NOTICE
• Do not operate request switch with
sharp metal object.
• Do not use high pressure water on
request switch.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(1)
(1)
80J056
(1) 80 cm (2 1/2 feet)
When the remote controller is within
approximately 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) from a
front door handle or the tailgate switch, you
can lock or unlock the doors by pushing
the request switch.
NOTE:
• If the remote controller is outside the
request
switch
operating
range
described above, you will not be able to
operate the request switch.
• If the battery of the remote controller
runs down or there are strong radio
waves or noise, the request switch operating range may be reduced or the
remote controller may be inoperative.
• If the remote controller is too close to the
door glass, the request switches may not
operate.
• If a spare remote controller is in the vehicle, the request switches may not operate normally.
• The remote controller will only operate a
request switch if it is within the switch’s
operating range. For example, if the
remote controller is within the operating
range of the driver’s door request switch
but not the front passenger’s door
request switch or the tailgate request
switch, the driver’s door switch can be
operated but the front passenger’s door
switch or tailgate switch cannot be operated.
NOTICE
The remote controller is a sensitive
electronic instrument. To avoid damaging the remote controller:
• Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as
by leaving it on the dashboard
under direct sunlight.
• Keep the remote controller away
from magnetic objects such as a
television.
NOTE:
The keyless push start system may not
function correctly in certain environments
or under certain operating conditions such
as the following:
• When there are strong signals coming
from a television, power station or a cellular phone.
• When the remote controller is in contact
with or covered by a metal object.
• When a radio wave type remote keyless
entry is used nearby.
• When the remote controller is placed
near an electronic device such as personal computer.
Some additional precautions you should
take and information you should be aware
of are:
• Make sure that the key is stowed in the
remote controller. If the remote controller
becomes unreliable, you will not be able
to lock or unlock the doors.
2-9
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
• Make sure that the driver always carries
the remote controller.
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,
ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as possible for a replacement. Have your dealer program the
new remote controller code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is
erased.
• You can use up to four remote controllers and the keys for your vehicle. Ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
for details.
• The battery life of the remote controller
is about two years, but it can vary
depending on usage conditions.
EXAMPLE
57L21016
To stow the key into the remote controller,
push the key in the remote controller until
you hear a click.
Press the request switch again after doing
the following:
With the ignition mode changed to LOCK
(OFF) by pressing the engine switch, bring
out the remote controller if it is inside the
vehicle and make sure that all doors are
completely closed.
EXAMPLE
(A)
Reminder function
EXAMPLE
54P000263
To remove the key from the remote controller, push the button (A) in arrow direction
and pull the key out from the remote controller.
Request switch warning buzzer
This exterior buzzer beeps for about 2 seconds in the following conditions to warn
you that the request switch will not work.
• The request switch is pressed after all
doors are closed with the ignition mode
changed to ACC or ON by pressing the
engine switch when the remote controller is outside the vehicle.
• The request switch is pressed in any of
the following conditions after changing
the ignition mode to LOCK (OFF) by
pressing the engine switch.
– The remote controller is left inside the
vehicle.
– Any door (including the tailgate) is
open.
66RH014
If the remote controller is not in the vehicle
under the following conditions, the buzzer
sounds intermittently for about 2 seconds
and the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light on the instrument cluster
blinks:
When one or more doors are opened and
all of the doors are later closed with the
ignition in any other mode than LOCK
(OFF).
2-10
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
The indicator light will turn off within several seconds after the remote controller is
returned to an area of the vehicle other
than the rear luggage area.
If the remote controller is left in the vehicle
and you lock the driver’s door or front passenger’s door as described below, the door
will be automatically unlocked.
• If you open the driver’s door and lock the
door by turning the lock knob forward or
pushing the power door locking switch,
the driver’s door will be automatically
unlocked.
• If you open the front passenger’s door
and lock the door by turning the lock
knob forward or pushing the power door
locking switch, the front passenger’s
door will be automatically unlocked.
NOTE:
• The reminder will not operate when the
remote controller is on the instrument
panel, in the glove box, in a storage
compartment, in the sun visor or on the
floor, etc.
• Make sure that the driver always carries
the remote controller.
• Do not leave the remote controller in the
vehicle when leaving the vehicle.
Battery replacement
If the remote controller becomes unreliable, replace the battery.
EXAMPLE
To replace the battery of the remote controller:
EXAMPLE
(1)
68LM210
(1) Lithium disc type battery:
CR2032 or equivalent
71LMT0201
1) Pull the key out from the remote controller.
2) Insert a flat-bladed screwdriver covered
with a soft cloth in the slot of the remote
controller and pry it open.
3) Replace the battery (1) so its + terminal
faces the bottom of the case as shown
in the illustration.
4) Close the remote controller firmly.
5) Make sure that the door locks can be
operated with the remote controller.
6) Dispose of the used battery properly
according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash.
2-11
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
WARNING
Swallowing a lithium battery may
cause serious internal injury. Do not
allow anyone to swallow a lithium
battery. Keep lithium batteries away
from children and pets. If swallowed,
contact a physician immediately.
Keyless entry system transmitter
(Type B)
EXAMPLE
NOTE:
You can switch the function that unlocks all
doors from requiring two pushes to requiring one push, and vice versa, via the information display setting mode. For details on
how to use the information display, refer to
“Information display” in this section.
NOTICE
• The remote controller is a sensitive
electronic instrument. To avoid
damaging it, do not expose it to
dust or moisture or tamper with
internal parts.
• When replacing the battery by
yourself, the remote controller
could be damaged affected by
static electricity. Discharge the
static electricity built up in your
body by touching metal before
replacing the battery.
NOTE:
Used batteries must be disposed properly
according to applicable rules or regulations
and must not be disposed with ordinary
household trash.
(1)
Central door locking system
• To lock all doors, push LOCK button (1)
once.
• To unlock only the driver’s door, push
UNLOCK button (2) once.
• To unlock other doors, push UNLOCK
button (2) once again.
(2)
66RM02001
(1) LOCK button
(2) UNLOCK button
You can lock or unlock all doors (including
the tailgate) simultaneously by operating
the transmitter near the vehicle.
The turn signal lights will flash once and
the siren will sound once when the doors
are locked.
When the doors are unlocked:
• The turn signal lights will flash twice and
the siren will sound twice.
• If the interior light switch is in DOOR
position, the interior light will turn on for
about 15 seconds and then fade out. If
you insert the key into the ignition switch
during this time, the light will start to fade
out immediately.
Make sure that the doors are locked after
you operate LOCK button (1).
NOTE:
If no door is opened within about 30 seconds after UNLOCK button (2) is operated,
the doors will automatically lock again.
2-12
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
• If you lock the doors using the transmitter when the engine hood is open, the
siren will sound 3 times to remind you.
• If the security system was triggered due
to an unauthorized entry into the vehicle
and then you unlock the doors using the
transmitter, the siren will sound 4 times
to remind you. If this happens, check
whether your vehicle has been broken
into while you were away from it.
• Once you push both of the LOCK button
(1) and UNLOCK button (2), then you
push one of the buttons within 5 seconds, the siren will not sound. However,
if you push one of the buttons twice
within 5 seconds, or push one of the buttons 5 seconds later, the siren will
sound.
NOTE:
• The maximum operating distance of the
keyless entry system transmitter is about
5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending
on the surroundings, especially near
other transmitting devices such as radio
towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.
• The door locks cannot be operated with
the transmitter, if the ignition key is
inserted in the ignition switch.
• When any door is open, the door locks
can only be unlocked with the transmitter, and the turn signal light will not flash.
• If you lose one of the transmitters, ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
as soon as possible for a replacement.
Have your dealer program the new
transmitter code in your vehicle’s memory so that the old code is erased.
Panic alarm function
This function is to get the attention of others. Push both of the LOCK button (1) and
UNLOCK button (2) for more than 3 seconds.
The turn signal lights will blink for about
27.5 seconds. Also, the siren will sound for
about 27.5 seconds at the same time.
To cancel the panic alarm, press any button (LOCK or UNLOCK). You can also
cancel the panic alarm by turning the ignition switch to “ON” position.
NOTE:
The panic alarm function will not activate
when the key is in the ignition switch.
NOTICE
The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging
the transmitter:
• Do not expose it to impacts, moisture or high temperature such as
by leaving it on the dashboard
under direct sunlight.
• Keep the transmitter away from
magnetic objects such as a television.
2-13
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Battery replacement
If the transmitter becomes unreliable,
replace the battery.
To replace the battery of the transmitter:
(1)
WARNING
EXAMPLE
Swallowing a lithium battery may
cause serious internal injury. Do not
allow anyone to swallow a lithium
battery. Keep lithium batteries away
from children and pets. If swallowed,
contact a physician immediately.
(2)
(3)
NOTICE
(2)
68LM249
(3) Lithium disc type battery:
CR1616 or equivalent
EXAMPLE
68LM248
1) Remove the screw (1), and open the
transmitter cover.
2) Remove the transmitter (2).
3) Put the edge of a flat-bladed screwdriver in the slot of the transmitter (2)
and pry it open.
4) Replace the battery (3) so its + terminal
faces “+” mark of the transmitter.
5) Close the transmitter and install it into
the transmitter holder.
6) Close the transmitter cover, install and
tighten the screw (1).
7) Make sure that the door locks can be
operated with the transmitter.
8) Dispose of the used battery properly
according to applicable rules or regulations. Do not dispose of lithium batteries with ordinary household trash.
• The transmitter is a sensitive electronic instrument. To avoid damaging it, do not expose it to dust or
moisture or tamper with internal
parts.
• When replacing the battery by
yourself, the transmitter could be
damaged affected by static electricity. Discharge the static electricity
built up in your body by touching
metal before replacing the battery.
2-14
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Security system (if equipped)
The security system is armed in about 5
seconds after you lock all doors (including
the tailgate) by using the keyless entry system transmitter, keyless push start system
remote controller or request switch.
Once the system is armed, any attempt to
open a door by using any other means (*)
than the keyless entry system transmitter,
keyless push start system remote controller or request switch, or open the engine
hood, will cause the alarm to be triggered.
* These means include the following:
– The key
– The lock knob on a door
– The central door locking switch
– The tailgate emergency lever
Also, in case that you have set the shock
sensor to enabled state and set sensitivity
of the pre-warning function and full blast
warning function to a level other than 0, the
alarm will be triggered if any attempt to
tamper with the vehicle. The shock sensor
can be selected enabled or disabled state,
and sensitivity of each warning can be
adjusted as desired. To set the shock sensor, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop or use the setting mode of the
information display.
NOTE:
• The default setting of the shock sensor
is in the disabled state. Set to the
enabled state and adjust sensitivity of
each warning according to your preference. For details on how to use the information display, refer to “Information
display” in this section.
• Your dealer may have already set the
shock sensor of the vehicle to the
enabled state before you purchase it.
Consult your dealer for further information.
NOTE:
• The security system generates alarms
when any of the predetermined conditions is met. However, the system does
not have any function of blocking unauthorized entry into the vehicle.
• Always use the keyless entry system
transmitter, keyless push start system
remote controller or request switch to
unlock the doors when the security system
has been armed. Using a key instead will
trigger the alarm.
• If a person who does not know the security system is going to drive the vehicle,
we recommend you explain the system
and its operation to the person, or disable the system beforehand. Mistakenly
triggering the alarm may cause a nuisance to others.
• Even if the security system is armed,
you should still be careful to guard
against theft. Do not leave money or
things of value in the vehicle.
How to arm the security system
(when enabled)
Lock all doors (including the tailgate) using
the keyless entry system transmitter, keyless push start system remote controller or
request switch. The security system indicator (1) will start blinking rapidly, and the
security system will be armed in about 5
seconds.
When the system is armed, the indicator
continues to blink at intervals of approximately 2 seconds.
EXAMPLE
(1)
62R0148
2-15
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
• To prevent the alarm from being accidentally triggered, avoid arming it while
anyone remains inside the vehicle. The
alarm will be triggered if any person
inside opens the door, tailgate, engine
hood, or swings the vehicle (if the shock
sensor is in the enabled state).
• The security system is not armed when
all doors are locked using the key from
outside, using the door lock knobs or the
central door locking switch from inside.
• If any door is not operated within approximately 30 seconds after the doors have
been unlocked using the keyless entry
system transmitter, keyless push start
system remote controller or request
switch, the doors are automatically
locked again. When the doors are
locked, the security system will be
armed in about 5 seconds if the system
is in the enabled state.
• If the security system indicator (1) blinks
when the ignition switch is in “ON” position or the ignition mode is ON, there
may be something wrong with the security system. Ask your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop to inspect the system.
How to disarm the security system
Simply unlock the doors using the keyless
push start system remote controller, the
request switch or the keyless entry system
transmitter. The security system indicator
will go out, indicating that the security system is disarmed.
How to stop the alarm
Should the alarm be triggered accidentally,
the alarm will stop by the following operations.
• Press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON or turn the ignition
switch to “ON” position.
• Unlock the doors using the keyless push
start system remote controller, the
request switch, or the keyless entry system transmitter.
NOTE:
• Even after the alarm has stopped, if you
lock the doors using the keyless entry
system transmitter, keyless push start
system remote controller or request
switch, the security system will be
rearmed with a delay of about 5 seconds.
• If you disconnect the battery while the
security system is in the armed condition
or the alarm is actually in operation, the
alarm will be re-triggered when the battery is then reconnected.
• Even after the alarm has stopped at the
end of the predetermined operation time,
it will be triggered again if any of the
doors, tailgate or engine hood is opened,
or the vehicle feels a shock (if the shock
sensor is in the enabled state), without
disarming the security system.
Checking whether the alarm has been
triggered during parking
If the alarm was triggered and you then
turn the ignition switch to “ON” position or
change the ignition mode to ON, the security system indicator will blink rapidly for
about 8 seconds and a buzzer will beep 4
times during this period. If this happens,
check whether the vehicle has been broken into while you were away from it.
Enabling and disabling the security
system
The security system can be either enabled
or disabled.
When enabled
• If any of the doors or tailgate are opened
without unlocking by the keyless entry
system transmitter, keyless push start
system remote controller or request
switch, all turn signal lights start to blink
and the interior buzzer beeps intermittently. After 5 seconds, the siren will
sound for about 27.5 seconds. The
security system indicator continues to
blink during this time.
• If the engine hood is opened, all turn signal lights blink, and the siren sounds for
about 27.5 seconds. The security system indicator continues to blink during
this time.
2-16
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
(If the shock sensor is in the enabled state)
• If the vehicle feels a shock higher than
the pre-warning sensitivity, the siren
sounds for about 2 seconds (pre-warning). If the vehicle feel a shock higher
than the full blast warning sensitivity, all
turn signal lights start to blink and the
interior buzzer beeps intermittently. After
5 seconds, the siren will sound for about
27.5 seconds (full blast warning). The
security system indicator continues to
blink during this time.
NOTE:
If you set the full blast warning sensitivity
higher than the pre-warning sensitivity in
the setting mode of the information display,
or the vehicle feels such shock as to be
able to trigger the full blast warning, the full
blast warning will be triggered preferentially. In this case, the pre-warning will not
be triggered.
How to switch the state of the security
system
When the security system has been
already disarmed, you can switch the system from the enabled state to the disabled
state, and vice versa, using the following
method.
EXAMPLE
1) Sit in the driver’s seat and make sure
that all doors, tailgate and engine hood
are closed.
(3)
• If any door is open, the open door
warning light comes on.
66RH015
EXAMPLE
3) Turn the knob on the lighting control
lever to the OFF position (3).
(2)
(1)
NOTE:
The following steps 4) and 5) must be
completed within 15 seconds.
EXAMPLE
When disabled
When the system is disabled, it stays disarmed even if you perform any system
arming operation.
75RM263
4 times
2) Turn the lock knob (1) on the driver’s
door rearward (2).
OFF
66RH016
2-17
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
4) Turn the knob on the lighting control
lever to the
position and then turn
back to the OFF position. Repeat this
operation 4 times.
EXAMPLE
(4)
3 times
(6)
(5)
66RH017
5) Push the lock end (4) (forward end) of
the central door locking switch (5), and
then push the unlock end (6) (backward
end). Repeat this operation 3 times.
System state
Number of beeps
Disabled
(Mode A)
Once
Enabled
(Mode D)
4 times
Windows
Manual window control
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
• If you cannot complete the operations in
step 4) and 5) within 15 seconds correctly, the state of the security system
will not change and the interior buzzer
does not beep. Perform the procedure
again from the beginning.
NOTE:
You can also switch the security system
from the enabled state to the disabled
state, and vice versa, via the setting mode
of the information display. For details on
how to use the information display, refer to
“Information display” in this section.
60G010A
Raise or lower the door windows by turning
the handle located on the door panel.
Every time you perform the series of the
above steps, the state of the security system changes from the currently selected
one to the other. You can check whether
the system is enabled or disabled by the
number of interior buzzer beeps at the end
of the procedure as follows.
2-18
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Electric window controls
(if equipped)
Passenger’s door
Driver’s side (Type B)
The electric windows can only be operated
when the ignition switch is in “ON” position
or the ignition mode is ON.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(1)
(3)
Driver’s side (Type A)
(5)
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(4)
(2)
66RH018
66RH019
66RH020
The driver’s door has a switch (1) to operate the driver’s window, and a switch (2) to
operate the front passenger’s window or
there are switches (3), (4), to operate the
rear right and left passenger windows,
respectively.
The passenger’s door has a switch (5) to
operate the passenger’s window.
2-19
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
CLOSE
EXAMPLE
Lock switch (Type A)
WARNING
EXAMPLE
OPEN
66RH021
81A009
To open a window, push the top part of the
switch. To close the window, lift up the top
part of the switch.
The driver’s window has AUTO-DOWN
feature for greater convenience (at toll
booths or drive-through restaurants, for
example). This means the driver can open
the window without holding the window
switch in DOWN position. Press down the
driver’s window switch completely and
release it. To stop the window before it
reaches the FULL-DOWN position, pull up
the switch briefly.
Lock switch (Type B)
EXAMPLE
66RH022
The driver’s door also has a lock switch for
the passenger’s window(s). When you
push in the lock switch, the passenger’s
window(s) cannot be raised or lowered by
operating any of the switches (2), (3), (4)
or (5). To restore normal operation, release
the lock switch by pushing it again.
• You should always lock the passenger’s window operation when
there are children in the vehicle.
Children can be seriously injured if
they get part of their body caught
by the window during operation.
• To avoid injuring an occupant by
window entrapment, make sure
that no part of the occupant’s body
such as hands or head is in the
path of the electric windows when
closing them.
• Always remove the ignition key or
take the keyless push start system
remote controller with you when
leaving the vehicle even only for a
short time. Also do not leave children alone in a parked vehicle.
Unattended children could use the
electric window switches and get
trapped by the window.
NOTE:
If you drive with one of the rear windows
open, you may hear a loud sound caused
by air vibration. To reduce the sound, open
the driver’s or front passenger’s window, or
narrow the rear window opening.
2-20
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Mirrors
Inside rearview mirror
You can adjust the inside rearview mirror
by hand to see the rear of your vehicle in
the mirror.
Type A
EXAMPLE
To adjust the mirror, set the selector tab (1)
to the day position, and then move the mirror up, down or sideways by hand to obtain
the best view.
When driving at night, you can move the
selector tab to the night position to reduce
glare from the headlights of vehicles
behind you.
WARNING
74LHT0235
Type B
EXAMPLE
• Always adjust the mirror with the
selector set to the day position.
• Only use the night position if it is
necessary to reduce glare from the
headlights of vehicles behind you.
Be aware that in this position you
may not be able to see some
objects that could be seen in the
day position.
Outside rearview mirrors
WARNING
Be careful when judging the size or
distance of a vehicle or other object
seen in the side convex mirror. Be
aware that objects look smaller and
appear farther away than when seen
in a flat mirror.
Type A
EXAMPLE
68LMT0205
66RH023
EXAMPLE
Adjust the outside rearview mirrors so you
can just see the side of your vehicle in the
mirrors.
(1)
(2)
(3)
68LMT0206
(2) Day driving
(3) Night driving
2-21
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Outside rearview mirror folding
switch (if equipped)
Type B
EXAMPLE
(1)
(3)
EXAMPLE
(2)
L
R
Never attempt to adjust the driver’s
seat or seatback while driving. The
seat or seatback could move unexpectedly, causing loss of control.
Make sure that the driver’s seat and
seatback are properly adjusted
before you start driving.
(4)
(1)
(3)
(4)
WARNING
66RH024
The switch to control the electric mirrors is
located on the driver’s door panel. You can
adjust the mirrors when the ignition switch
is in “ACC” or “ON” position, or the ignition
mode is ACC or ON. To adjust the mirrors:
1) Move the selector switch to the left or
right to select the mirror you wish to
adjust.
2) Press the outer part of the switch that
corresponds to the direction in which
you wish to move the mirror.
3) Return the selector switch to the center
position to help prevent unintended
adjustment.
Seat adjustment
WARNING
(2)
(1)
Front seats
66RH025
You can fold the mirrors when you park the
vehicle in a narrow space. When the ignition switch is in “ACC” or “ON” position, or
the ignition mode is ACC or ON, push the
folding switch (1) to fold and unfold the mirrors. Make sure that the mirrors are completely unfolded before you start driving.
CAUTION
Moving mirrors can pinch and injure
a hand. Do not allow anyone’s hand
to get near the mirrors when folding
and unfolding the mirrors.
To avoid excessive seat belt slack,
which reduces the effectiveness of
the seat belts as a safety device,
make sure that the seats are adjusted
before the seat belts are fastened.
WARNING
All seatbacks should always be in an
upright position when driving, or seat
belt effectiveness may be reduced.
Seat belts are designed to offer maximum protection when seatbacks are
in the upright position.
2-22
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
EXAMPLE
Head restraints
NOTE:
It may be necessary to recline the seatback to provide enough overhead clearance to remove the head restraint.
EXAMPLE
Front
EXAMPLE
63J246
(2)
(3)
(1)
66RH155
Seat position adjustment lever (1)
Pull the lever up and slide the seat.
Seatback angle adjustment lever (2)
Pull the lever up and move the seatback.
Seat height adjustment lever (3)
(if equipped)
Pull the lever up to raise the seat. Push the
lever down to lower the seat.
Head restraints are designed to help
reduce the risk of neck injuries in the case
of an accident. Adjust the head restraint to
the position which places the center of the
head restraint closest to the top of your
ears. If this is not possible for very tall passengers, adjust the head restraint as high
as possible.
WARNING
• Never drive the vehicle with the
head restraints removed.
• Do not attempt to adjust the head
restraint while driving.
75RM004
To raise the front head restraint, pull
upward the head restraint until it clicks. To
lower the head restraint, push down the
head restraint while holding in the lock
lever. If a head restraint must be removed
(for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in
the lock lever and pull the head restraint all
the way out.
After adjustment, move the seat and seatback forward and backward to check that it
is securely latched.
2-23
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Rear seats
Folding rear seats
Rear
The rear seat(s) of your vehicle can be
folded forward to provide additional cargo
space.
Head restraints (if equipped)
Head restraints are designed to help
reduce the risk of neck injuries in the case
of an accident.
To fold the rear seat(s) forward:
1) Lower the head restraint (if equipped)
fully.
WARNING
• Never drive the vehicle with the
head restraints removed.
• Do not attempt to adjust the head
restraint while driving.
NOTE:
It may be necessary to fold forward the
seatback to provide enough overhead
clearance to remove the head restraint.
Adjust the head restraint to the position
which places the center of the head
restraint closest to the top of your ears. If
this is not possible for very tall passengers,
adjust the head restraint as high as possible.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
75RM006
To raise the rear head restraint, pull
upward the head restraint until it clicks. To
lower the head restraint, push down the
head restraint while holding in the lock
lever. If a head restraint must be removed
(for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in
the lock lever and pull the head restraint all
the way out.
When installing a child restraint system,
adjust the height of the head restraint or
remove it for fitting the child restraint, as
necessary.
75RM007
2) Hook the webbing of the outboard lapshoulder belts and latch plates in the
belt hangers.
2-24
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTICE
NOTICE
NOTICE
• When you move a seatback, make
sure the belt webbing is hooked in
the seat belt hangers so the seat
belts are not caught by the seatback, seat hinge, or seat latch. This
helps prevent damage to the belt
system.
• Make sure the belt webbing is not
twisted.
After folding the rear seatback forward, do not allow any foreign material to enter the lock opening. This
may cause damage to the inside of
the lock and prevent the seatback
from being locked securely.
When returning the rear seatback to
the normal position, make sure that
there is nothing around the striker.
Any foreign materials prevent the
seatback from being locked securely.
WARNING
EXAMPLE
If you need to carry cargo in the passenger compartment with the rear
seatback folded forward, secure the
cargo or it may be thrown about,
causing injury. Never pile cargo
higher than the seatbacks.
EXAMPLE
To return the seat to the normal position,
follow the procedure below.
CAUTION
66RH027
3) Pull the release knob on the top of the
seat(s), and fold the seatback forward.
When returning the rear seatback to
the normal position, be careful that
your finger is not caught between the
lock and the striker.
66RH087
Raise the seatback until it locks into place.
After returning the seat, move the seatback forward and backward to check that it
is securely latched.
CAUTION
Do not put your hand into the rear
seatback lock opening, or your finger
may get caught and be injured.
2-25
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTICE
• When returning the rear seatback
to the normal position, do not allow
any foreign material to enter the
lock opening. This may prevent the
seatback
from
being
locked
securely.
• When returning the rear seatback
to the normal position, handle it
carefully by hand to avoid any damage to the lock itself. Do not push it
by using some material or by
applying excessive force.
• As the lock is designed exclusively
for securing the rear seatback, do
not use it for any other purpose.
Incorrect use of it may cause damage to the inside of the lock and
prevent the seatback from being
locked securely.
Seat belts and child restraint
systems
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
Above the pelvis
65D606
65D231S
WARNING
Wear your seat belts at all times.
WARNING
An air bag supplements or adds to
the frontal crash protection offered
by seat belts. The driver and all passengers must be properly restrained
by fastening seat belts at all times,
whether or not an air bag is mounted
at their seating position, to minimize
the risk of severe injury or death in
the event of a crash.
WARNING
• Never allow persons to ride in the
cargo area of a vehicle. In the event
of an accident, there is a much
greater risk of injury for persons
who are not riding in a seat with
their seat belt securely fastened.
• Seat belts should always be
adjusted as follows:
– the lap portion of the belt should
be worn low across the pelvis,
not across the waist.
– the shoulder straps should be
worn on the outside shoulder
only, and never under the arm.
– the shoulder straps should be
away from your face and neck,
but not falling off your shoulder.
(Continued)
2-26
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
as low as possible
across the hips
Across the pelvis
65D201
WARNING
(Continued)
• Seat belts should never be worn
with the straps twisted and should
be adjusted as tightly as is comfortable to provide the protection
for which they have been designed.
A slack belt will provide less protection than a snug belt.
• Make sure that each seat belt
buckle is inserted into the proper
buckle catch. It is possible to cross
the buckles in the rear seat.
(Continued)
65D199
WARNING
(Continued)
• Pregnant women should use seat
belts, although specific recommendations about driving should be
made by the woman’s medical advisor. Remember that the lap portion
of the belt should be worn as low
as possible across the hips, as
shown in the illustration.
• Do not fasten your seat belt over
hard or breakable objects in your
pockets or on your clothing. If an
accident occurs, objects such as
glasses, pens, etc. under the seat
belt can cause injury.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Never use the same seat belt for
more than one occupant and never
attach a seat belt over an infant or
child being held on an occupant’s
lap. Such seat belt use could cause
serious injury in the event of an
accident.
• Periodically inspect seat belt
assemblies for excessive wear and
damage. Seat belts should be
replaced if webbing becomes
frayed, contaminated or damaged
in any way. It is essential to replace
the entire seat belt assembly after it
has been worn in a severe impact,
even if damage to the assembly is
not obvious.
• Children aged 12 and under should
ride properly restrained in the rear
seat.
• Infants and small children should
never be transported unless they
are properly restrained. Restraint
systems for infants and small children can be purchased locally and
should be used. Make sure that the
system you purchase meets applicable safety standards. Read and
follow all the directions provided
by the manufacturer.
(Continued)
2-27
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
WARNING
(Continued)
• For children, if the shoulder belt
irritates the neck or face, move the
child closer to the center of the
vehicle.
• Avoid contamination of seat belt
webbing by polishes, oils, chemicals, and particularly battery acid.
Cleaning may safely be carried out
using mild soap and water.
• Do not insert any items such as
coins and clips into the seat belt
buckles, and be careful not to spill
liquids into these parts. If foreign
materials get into a seat belt
buckle, the seat belt may not work
properly.
• All seatbacks should always be in
an upright position when driving,
or seat belt effectiveness may be
reduced. Seat belts are designed to
offer maximum protection when
seatbacks are in the upright position.
Lap-shoulder belt
Emergency locking retractor (ELR)
The seat belt has an emergency locking
retractor (ELR), which is designed to lock
the seat belt only during a sudden stop or
impact. It also may lock if you pull the belt
across your body very quickly. If this happens, let the belt go back to unlock it, and
then pull the belt across your body more
slowly.
EXAMPLE
Low on hips
Safety reminder
EXAMPLE
Sit up straight and
fully back
60A040
Low on hips
To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt
during a crash, position the lap portion of
the belt across your lap as low on your hips
as possible and adjust it to a snug fit by
pulling the shoulder portion of the belt
upward through the latch plate. The length
of the diagonal shoulder strap adjusts itself
to allow freedom of movement.
60A038
2-28
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
All seat belts except rear center
All seat belts except rear center are the
lap-shoulder belt.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
60A036
To fasten the seat belt, sit up straight and
far back into the seat, pull the latch plate
attached to the seat belt across your body
and press it straight into the buckle until
you hear a click.
80J2008
60A039
NOTE:
The word “CENTER” is marked on the
buckle for the rear center belt. The buckles
are designed so a latch plate cannot be
inserted into the wrong buckle.
To unfasten the seat belt, push the red
“PRESS” button on the buckle and retract
the belt slowly while holding the belt or/and
the latch plate.
2-29
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Lap belt
TO LOOSEN
Rear center seat belt
To fasten the belt, pull the latch plate
attached to the seat belt across your hips
and press it straight into the buckle until
you hear a click. To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt during a collision, position the belt across your lap as low on your
hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit.
TO TIGHTEN
To unfasten the belt, press the release button on the buckle catch.
EXAMPLE
Right angle
EXAMPLE
80JS029
Low on hips
EXAMPLE
To lengthen, release the latch plate from
the buckle, pull the latch plate (adjuster) in
the direction of the arrow, at right angles to
the belt. The latch plate should then be
refitted into the buckle and the belt tightened as previously described.
79MH0239
NOTE:
The word “CENTER” is marked on the
buckle for the rear center belt. The buckles
are designed so a latch plate cannot be
inserted into the wrong buckle.
80JS028
To tighten the belt, pull the free end of the
belt across alongside the lap strap.
2-30
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Driver’s seat belt reminder
With tachometer
EXAMPLE
66RH028
Without tachometer
EXAMPLE
If the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled
when the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, the
reminder works as follows:
1) The driver’s seat belt reminder light will
come on.
2) After the vehicle’s speed has reached
about 15 km/h, the driver’s seat belt
reminder light will blink and a buzzer
will sound for about 95 seconds.
3) The reminder light will remain on until
the driver’s seat belt is buckled.
If the driver has buckled his or her seat belt
and later unbuckles the seat belt, the
reminder system will be activated from
Step 1) or 2) according to the vehicle’s
speed. When the vehicle’s speed is less
than 15 km/h, the reminder will start from
Step 1). When the vehicle’s speed is more
than 15 km/h, the reminder will start from
Step 2).
The reminder will be automatically canceled when the driver’s seat belt is buckled
or the ignition switch is turned off, or the
engine switch is pressed to change the
ignition mode to LOCK (OFF).
WARNING
It is absolutely essential that the
driver and passengers fasten their
seat belts at all times. Persons who
are not fastening seat belts have a
much greater risk of injury if an accident occurs. Make a regular habit of
buckling your seat belt before putting
the key in the ignition or pressing the
engine switch.
66RH029
2-31
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Rear outside seat belt guide
Seat belt inspection
EXAMPLE
WARNING
EXAMPLE
Inspect all seat belt assemblies after
any crash. Any seat belt assembly
which was in use during a crash
(other than a very minor one) should
be replaced, even if damage to the
assembly is not obvious. Any seat
belt assembly which was not in use
during a crash should be replaced if
it does not function properly, it is
damaged in any way or the seat belt
pretensioners were activated (that is,
if the front air bags were activated).
75RM007
68PH00242
When you move a seatback, make sure
the belt webbing and latch plate are
hooked in the seat belt hangers.
Periodically check if the seat belts work
properly and are not damaged. Make sure
the webbing, buckles, latch plates, retractors, anchorages and guide loops. Replace
any seat belts which do not work properly
or are damaged.
2-32
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Child restraint systems
Child restraint
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
60G332
Infant restraint - rear seat only
EXAMPLE
80JC016
Booster seat
EXAMPLE
MARUTI SUZUKI highly recommends that
you use a child restraint system to restrain
infants and small children. Many different
types of child restraint systems are available; make sure that the restraint system
you select meets applicable safety standards.
All child restraint systems are designed to
be secured in vehicle seats either by seat
belts (lap belts or the lap portion of lapshoulder belts) or by special rigid lower
anchor bars built into the seat. Whenever
possible, MARUTI SUZUKI recommends
that child restraint systems be installed on
the rear seat. According to accident statistics, children are safer when properly
restrained in rear seating positions than in
front seating positions.
If you must use a front facing child restraint
in the front passenger’s seat, adjust the
passenger’s seat as far back as possible.
NOTE:
Observe any statutory regulation about
child restraints.
80JC007
80JC008
2-33
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Children could be endangered in a
crash if their child restraint systems
are not properly secured in the vehicle. When installing a child restraint
system, follow the instructions
below. Secure the child in the
restraint system according to the
manufacturer’s instructions.
58MS030
WARNING
65D608
EXAMPLE
Do not install a rear-facing child
restraint in the front passenger’s
seat. If the passenger’s front air bag
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child
restraint could be killed or severely
injured. The back of a rear-facing
child restraint would be too close to
the inflating air bag.
WARNING
If you install a child restraint system
in the rear seat, slide the front seat
far enough forward so that the child’s
feet do not touch the front seatback.
This will help avoid injury to the child
in the event of an accident.
65D609
2-34
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Installation with lap-shoulder seat
belts
Installation with a lap belt
ELR type belt
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
CAUTION
Adjust the height of the rear head
restraint (if equipped) or remove it for
fitting the child restraint, as necessary. However, if a booster cushion
not equipped with the head restraint
is fitted, the rear seat head restraint
should not be removed. If the rear
head restraint is removed for fitting
the child restraint, you need to install
it again after removing the child
restraint.
If the child restraint is fitted improperly, a child sitting in it could be
injured in a crash.
NOTE:
Stow the removed head restraint (if
equipped) in the luggage compartment so
it will not cause inconvenience to the occupants.
Pull to tighten
68PH00243
68PH00244
Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child
restraint system manufacturer.
Install your child restraint system according to the instructions provided by the child
restraint system manufacturer.
Make sure that the seat belt is securely
latched.
Move the child restraint system in all directions to check that it is securely installed.
When you put your child in the child
restraint system, appropriately slide the
front seat forward not to touch a part of
your child’s body.
To lengthen or tighten the belt, refer to the
“Lap-belt” item in this “Seat belts and child
restraint systems” section. After making
sure that the seat belt is securely latched,
try moving the child restraint system in all
directions, to make sure it is securely
installed. If you need to tighten the belt,
pull the free end of the webbing.
2-35
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Installation with ISOFIX type
anchorages (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Install the ISOFIX type child restraint system according to the instructions provided
by the child restraint system manufacturer.
After installation, try moving the child
restraint system in all directions especially
forward to check that connecting bars are
securely latched to the anchorages.
EXAMPLE
66RH144
Your vehicle is equipped with the lower
anchorages in the rear seat outboard seating positions for securing a ISOFIX type of
child restraints with the connecting bars.
The lower anchorages are located where
the rear of the seat cushion meets the bottom of the seatback.
WARNING
Install the ISOFIX type of child
restraint(s) in the only outboard seating positions, not in the central position for the rear seat.
84MM00252
Your vehicle is equipped with the top tether
anchorages. Use the top tether strap of the
child restraint according to the instructions
provided by the child restraint system manufacturer.
Here is a general instruction:
CAUTION
Adjust the height of the rear head
restraint or remove it for fitting the
child restraint, as necessary. However, if a booster cushion not
equipped with the head restraint is
fitted, the rear seat head restraint
should not be removed. If the rear
head restraint is removed for fitting
the child restraint, you need to install
it again after removing the child
restraint.
If the child restraint is fitted improperly, a child sitting in it could be
injured in a crash.
NOTE:
Stow the removed head restraint in the luggage compartment so it will not cause
inconvenience to the occupants.
2-36
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
2) Use your hands to carefully align the
connecting bar tips with the anchorages. Take care not to pinch your fingers.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
78F114
54G185
1) Place the child restraint in the rear seat,
inserting the connecting bars to the
anchorages between the seat cushion
and the seatback.
4) Grasp the front of the child restraint and
push the child restraint forcefully to
latch the connecting bars. Make sure
that they are securely latched by trying
to move the child restraint system in all
directions, especially forward.
5) Attach the top tether strap referring to
“Installation of child restraint with top
tether” section below.
When you put your child in the child
restraint system, appropriately slide the
front seat forward not to touch a part of
your child’s body.
EXAMPLE
54G184
3) Push the child restraint toward the anchorages so that the connecting bar tips are
partially hooked to the anchorages. Use
your hands to confirm the position.
68LM268
2-37
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTICE
When installing a child restraint system to the rear seat, adjust the front
seat position so that the front seat
does not interfere with the child
restraint system.
Installation of child restraint with
top tether
Front
1) Remove the luggage compartment cover
(if equipped).
2) Secure the child restraint on the rear
seat using the procedure described
above for securing a restraint system
that does not require a top tether strap.
3) Hook the top tether strap to the top
tether anchorage bracket and tighten
the top tether strap according to the
instructions provided by the child
restraint system manufacturer. Attach
the top tether strap to the corresponding top tether anchorage bracket
located directly behind the child
restraint. Do not attach the top tether
strap to the luggage restraint loops (if
equipped).
WARNING
EXAMPLE
66RH145
Some child restraint systems require the
use of a top tether strap. Top tether anchorage brackets are provided in your vehicle at
the locations shown in the illustrations.
The number of the top tether anchorage
brackets provided in your vehicle depends
on the vehicle specification. Install the child
restraint system as follows:
Do not attach the child restraint top
tether strap to the luggage restraint
loops (if equipped). Incorrectly
attached top tether strap will reduce
the intended effectiveness of the
child restraint system.
Type 1
EXAMPLE
Type 2
66RH146
4) When routing the top tether strap, pass
the top tether strap as shown in the
illustration (Refer to “Head restraints”
section for details on how to remove the
head restraint).
5) Make sure that cargo does not interfere
with routing of the top tether strap.
NOTICE
When installing a child restraint system to the rear seat, adjust the front
seat position so that the front seat
does not interfere with the child
restraint system.
NOTE:
Maruti Suzuki recommends use of Maruti
Suzuki Genuine accessory of “Child seat,
ISOFIX”.
2-38
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Child Restraint System for India
Child Restraint
The suitability of each passenger’s seat position for carriage of children and fitting of child restraint system is shown in the table below.
Whenever you carry children up to 12 years of age, properly use the child restraints which conform to AIS 072, the standard for child
restraints, referring to the table.
Seating position (or other site)
Front
Passenger
Rear
Outboard
Rear
Centre
Intermediate
Outboard
Intermediate
Centre
Group 0
Up to 10 kg
X
U
X
N.A.
N.A.
Group 0+
Up to 13 kg
X
U
X
N.A.
N.A.
Group I
9 to 18 kg
X
U
X
N.A.
N.A.
Group II
15 to 25 kg
X
U
X
N.A.
N.A.
Group III
22 to 36 kg
X
U
X
N.A.
N.A.
MASS GROUP
Key of letters to be inserted in the above table:
U =Suitable for ‘universal’ category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
X =Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
N.A = Seat position not available for children in this mass group.
NOTE: ‘universal’ is the category in the AIS 072.
: ‘Outboard’ indicates window side seat.
2-39
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Seat belt pretensioner system
EXAMPLE
11
11
Label
66RM02002
WARNING
This section describes your MARUTI
SUZUKI vehicle’s seat belt pretensioner system. Read and follow all
these instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe injury or
death.
To determine if your vehicle is equipped
with a seat belt pretensioner system at the
front seating positions, make sure the label
on the seat belt at the bottom part. If the
letter “E11” appear as illustrated, your
vehicle is equipped with the seat belt pretensioner system. You can use the pretensioner seat belts in the same manner as
ordinary seat belts.
Read this section and “Supplemental
restraint system (air bags)” section to learn
more about the pretensioner system.
The seat belt pretensioner system works
with the supplemental restraint system (air
bags). The crash sensors and the electronic controller of the air bag system also
control the seat belt pretensioners. The
pretensioners are triggered only when
there is a frontal crash severe enough to
trigger the air bags and the seat belts are
fastened. For precautions and general
information including servicing the pretensioner system, refer to “Supplemental
restraint system (air bags)” section in addition to this “Seat belt pretensioner system”
section, and follow all those precautions.
The pretensioner is located in each front
seat belt retractor. The pretensioner tightens the seat belt so the belt fits the occupant’s body more snugly in the event of a
frontal crash. The retractors will remain
locked after the pretensioners are activated. Upon activation, some noise will
occur and some smoke may be released.
These conditions are not harmful and do
not indicate a fire in the vehicle.
The driver and all passengers must be
properly restrained by fastening seat belts
at all times, whether or not a pretensioner
is equipped at their seating position, to
minimize the risk of severe injury or death
in the event of a crash.
Sit fully back in the seat; sit up straight; do
not lean forward or sideways. Adjust the
belt so the lap portion of the belt is worn
low across the pelvis, not across the waist.
Please refer to “Seat adjustment” section
and the instructions and precautions about
the seat belts in this “Seat belts and child
restraint systems” section for details on
proper seat and seat belt adjustments.
Please note that the pretensioners along
with the air bags will activate in severe
frontal crashes. They are not designed to
activate in rear impacts, roll-overs, or
minor frontal crashes. The pretensioners
can be activated only once. If the pretensioners are activated (that is, if the air bags
are activated), have authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop as soon as possible.
2-40
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
If the AIR BAG light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on briefly when
the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, stays on
for more than 10 seconds, or comes on
while driving, the pretensioner system or
the air bag system may not work properly.
Have both systems inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as
possible.
Do not touch pretensioner system components or wiring. The wires are wrapped
with yellow tape or yellow tubing, and the
couplers are yellow. When scrapping your
vehicle, ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop body repair shop, or scrap yard
for assistance.
Service on or around the pretensioner system components or wiring must be performed only by an authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop who is specially trained.
Improper service could result in unintended activation of pretensioners or could
render the pretensioner inoperative. Either
of these two conditions may result in personal injury.
To prevent damage or unintended activation of the pretensioners, make sure that
the battery is disconnected and the ignition
switch has been in “LOCK” position or the
ignition mode has been LOCK (OFF) for at
least 90 seconds before performing any
electrical service work on your vehicle.
2-41
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Supplemental restraint
system (Air bags)
EXAMPLE
WARNING
This section describes the protection
provided by your vehicle’s supplemental restraint system (air bags).
Read and follow all instructions carefully to minimize your risk of severe
injury or death in the event of a
crash.
(3)
(2)
(5)
Your vehicle is equipped with a supplemental restraint system consisting of the
following components in addition to a lapshoulder belt at each seating position.
(1) Driver’s front air bag module
(2) Front passenger’s front air bag module
(3) Front seat belt pretensioners
(4) Air bag controller
(5) Forward crash sensor
(1)
(4)
(3)
66RM02005
2-42
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Front air bags
Air bag symbol meaning
WARNING
An air bag supplements or adds to
the crash protection offered by seat
belts. The driver and all passengers
must be properly restrained by fastening seat belts at all times, whether
or not an air bag is mounted at their
seating position, to minimize the risk
of severe injury or death in the event
of a crash.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
“AIR BAG” light
68PH00247
72M00150
You may find this label on the sun visor.
WARNING
63J030
If the AIR BAG light on the instrument cluster does not blink or come on when the
ignition switch is first turned to “ON” position, or the ignition mode is first changed to
ON, or AIR BAG light stays on, or comes
on while driving, the air bag system (or the
seat belt pretensioner system) may not
work properly. Have the air bag system
inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop as soon as possible.
NEVER use a rearward facing child
restraint on a seat protected by an
ACTIVE AIRBAG in front of it, DEATH
or SERIOUS INJURY to the CHILD
can occur.
Front air bags are designed to inflate in
severe frontal crashes when the ignition
switch is in “ON” position or the ignition
mode is ON.
Front air bags are not designed to inflate in
rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers or
minor frontal crashes, since they would
offer no protection in those types of accidents. Since an air bag deploys only one
time during an accident, seat belts are
needed to restrain occupants from further
movements during the accident.
Therefore, an air bag is not a substitute for
seat belts. To maximize your protection,
always fasten your seat belts. Be aware
that no system can prevent all possible
injuries that may occur in an accident.
2-43
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Driver’s front air bag
EXAMPLE
located behind the passenger’s side of the
dashboard.
The words “SRS AIRBAG” are molded into
the air bag covers to identify the location of
the air bags.
Conditions of front air bags deployment
(inflation)
EXAMPLE
80J097
• Frontal crash with a fixed wall that does
not move or deform in more than about
25 km/h.
81P30640
Front passenger’s front air bag
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
58MS030
WARNING
62R0135
The driver’s front air bag is located behind
the center pad of the steering wheel and
the front passenger’s front air bag is
Do not install a rear-facing child
restraint in the front passenger’s
seat. If the passenger’s front air bag
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child
restraint could be killed or severely
injured. The back of a rear-facing
child restraint would be too close to
the inflating air bag.
Refer to “Seat belts and child restraint systems” section for details on securing your
child.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(1)
80J098E
• Crash such as above at an angle of
about 30 degrees (1) or less from the
front.
2-44
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Conditions of front air bags may inflate
Receiving a strong impact to the lower
body of your vehicle, the front air bags will
inflate in many cases.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
80J101
80J099
• Hitting a curb or medial strip.
EXAMPLE
80J119
• Landing hard or falling.
• Crash from the side.
Front air bags might inflate in a strong
impact
Front air bags do not inflate basically in
rear collision, side collision or rollovers,
etc., however, these might inflate in a
strong impact.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
80J110
• Vehicle rollover.
80J100E
• Falling into a deep hole or ditch.
80J120
• Crash from the rear.
2-45
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Front air bags may not inflate
The front air bags may not inflate when the
impact is absorbed since the crash object
moved, vehicle body deformed, or crash
angle was greater than about 30 degrees
from the front.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
80J104
• Crash with a utility pole or stumpage.
80J102
• Approximately 50 km/h or lower speed
frontal crash to a stopped vehicle.
EXAMPLE
80J106
• Frontal crash with a fixed wall that does
not move or deform in less than about 25
km/h.
EXAMPLE
(1)
EXAMPLE
80J105E
80J103
• Crash that the front of your vehicle goes
under the bed of a truck etc.
• Crash with a fixed wall or guardrail at an
angle of greater than about 30 degrees
(1) from the front.
80J107
• Crash angle is offset from the vehicle
angle (offset crash).
2-46
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
How the system works
In a frontal crash, the crash sensors will
detect rapid deceleration, and if the controller judges that the deceleration represents a severe frontal crash, the
controller will trigger the inflators. The inflators inflate the appropriate air bags with
nitrogen or argon gas. The inflated air
bags provide a cushion for your head and
upper body. The air bag inflates and
deflates so quickly that you may not even
realize that it has activated. The air bag will
neither hinder your view nor make it harder
to exit the vehicle.
Air bags must inflate quickly and forcefully
in order to reduce the chance of serious or
fatal injuries. However, an unavoidable
consequence of the quick inflation is that
the air bag may irritate bare skin, such as
the facial area against a front air bag. Also,
upon inflation, a loud noise will occur and
some powder and smoke will be released.
These conditions are not harmful and do
not indicate a fire in the vehicle. Be aware,
however, that some air bag components
may be hot for a while after inflation.
A seat belt helps keep you in the proper
position for maximum protection when an
air bag inflates. Adjust your seat as far
back as possible while still maintaining
control of the vehicle. Sit fully back in your
seat; sit up straight; do not lean over the
steering wheel or dashboard. Front occupants should not lean on or sleep against
the door. Refer to “Seat adjustment” section and “Seat belts and child restraint systems” section in this section for details on
proper seat and seat belt adjustments.
EXAMPLE
65D610
WARNING
• The driver should not lean over the
steering wheel. The front passenger should not rest his or her body
against the dashboard, or otherwise get too close to the dashboard. In these situations, the outof-position occupant would be too
close to an inflating air bag, and
may suffer severe injury.
• Do not attach any objects to, or
place any objects over, the steering
wheel or dashboard. Do not place
any objects between the air bag
and the driver or front passenger.
These objects may interfere with air
bag operation or may be propelled
by the air bag in the event of a
crash. Either of these conditions
may cause severe injury.
Even though your vehicle is moderately
damaged by a crash, it may not be severe
enough to trigger front air bags to inflate. If
your vehicle sustains any front-end or side
damage, have the air bag system
inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop to ensure that it works properly.
Your vehicle is equipped with a diagnostic
module which records information about
the air bag system if the air bags deploy in
a crash. The module records information
about overall system status, and which
sensors activated the deployment.
2-47
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Servicing the air bag system
If the air bags inflate, have the air bags
and related components replaced by an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as
soon as possible.
If your vehicle ever gets in deep water and
the driver’s floor is submerged, the air bag
controller could be damaged. If this happens, ask authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to check the air bag system as soon
as possible.
Special procedures are required for servicing or replacing an air bag. For that reason, only an authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop should be allowed to service or
replace your air bags. Remind anyone who
services your vehicle that it has air bags.
To prevent damage or unintended inflation
of the air bag system, make sure that the
battery is disconnected and the ignition
switch has been in “LOCK” position or the
ignition mode has been LOCK (OFF) for at
least 90 seconds before performing any
electrical service work on your vehicle. Do
not touch air bag system components or
wires. The wires are wrapped with yellow
tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are
yellow for easy identification.
Scrapping a vehicle that has an uninflated
air bag can be hazardous. Ask your dealer,
body repair shop or scrap yard for help
with disposal.
Service on or around air bag components
or wiring must be performed only by an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Improper service could result in unintended air bag deployment or could render
the air bag inoperative. Either of these two
conditions may result in severe injury.
2-48
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Instrument cluster
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Speedometer
Tachometer (if equipped)
Information display
Warning and indicator lights
With tachometer
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
(3)
(2)
FOR DIESEL
(4)
(4)
66RM02003
2-49
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Speedometer
Without tachometer
EXAMPLE
The speedometer indicates vehicle speed.
(1)
Tachometer (if equipped)
The tachometer indicates engine speed in
revolutions per minute.
NOTICE
Never drive the vehicle with the
engine revving in the red zone or
severe engine damage can result.
Keep the engine speed below the red
zone even when downshifting to a
lower gear position.
Refer to “Downshifting maximum
allowable speeds” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
(4)
(3)
(4)
66RH098
2-50
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Fuel gauge
amount of fuel in the fuel tank. “F” stands
for full and “E” stands for empty.
• If the indicator shows only one segment
to “E”, refill the tank as soon as possible.
If the last segment blinks, it means that
the fuel is almost empty.
With tachometer
If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on,
fill the fuel tank immediately.
Refer to “Low fuel warning light” in “Warning and indicator lights” in this section for
details.
(1)
(2)
EXAMPLE
75RM248
Without tachometer
The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler
door is located on the left side of the vehicle.
Brightness control
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, the instrument cluster lights or pointer lights come
on.
Your vehicle has a system to automatically
dim the brightness of the instrument cluster lights when the position lights or headlights are on.
You can change the brightness of the
instrument cluster lights;
• For the instrument cluster with tachometer, regardless of whether the position
lights or headlights are off or on.
• For the instrument cluster without
tachometer, when the position lights and/
or headlights are ON.
To switch the display indication to the
brightness control, refer to “Information
display” in this section.
WARNING
Do not adjust the brightness of the
instrument panel lights while driving.
Otherwise, you could lose control of
the vehicle.
(1)
(2)
EXAMPLE
75RM249
When the ignition switch is in “ON” position
or the ignition mode is ON, this gauge
gives an approximate indication of the
2-51
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
With tachometer
To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, push “+” side of the
brightness control switch (1). To change
the brightness quickly, push and hold the
switch.
To reduce the brightness of the instrument
panel lights, push “–” side of the brightness
control switch (1). To change the brightness quickly, push and hold the switch.
EXAMPLE
75RM208
EXAMPLE
(1)
66RH114
NOTE:
• If you do not push the brightness control
switch within several seconds of activating the brightness control, the brightness
control display will be canceled automatically.
• When you reconnect the battery, the
brightness of the instrument cluster
lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the
brightness according to your preference.
NOTE:
If you select the maximum brightness level
when the position lights or headlights are
on, the following functions will be canceled.
• The function which automatically dims
the brightness of instrument cluster
lights.
• The function which operates with the
brightness control, except maximum
brightness level.
Without tachometer
(2)
(3)
(4)
EXAMPLE
75RM209
(2) Brightest
(3) Initial setting
(4) Dimmest
2-52
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
If you select the maximum brightness level
when the position lights or headlights are
on, the following functions will be canceled.
• The function which automatically dims
the brightness of instrument cluster
lights.
• The function which operates with the
brightness control, except maximum
brightness level.
EXAMPLE
Information display
(instrument cluster with
tachometer)
The information display is shown when the
ignition switch is in “ON” position or the
ignition mode is ON.
EXAMPLE
(A)
(5)
(C)
75RM266
To increase the brightness of the instrument panel lights, turn the brightness control knob (5) clockwise.
To reduce the brightness of the instrument
panel lights, turn the brightness control
knob (5) counterclockwise.
NOTE:
• If you do not turn the brightness control
knob within several seconds of activating the brightness control, the brightness
control display will be canceled automatically.
• When you reconnect the battery, the
brightness of the instrument cluster
lights will be reinitialized. Readjust the
brightness according to your preference.
(B)
(E)
(F)
(D)
(1)
(G)
75RM042
(1) Information display
2-53
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Clock
Display (D)
Gear position
(for Auto Gear Shift models) /
Gearshift indicator (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
The display (A) shows the time.
To set the clock, follow “Setting mode”
instructions in this section.
Display (E)
Trip meter
Thermometer
The display (B) shows the thermometer.
Display (F)
Odometer
The thermometer indicates the outside
temperature.
Display (G)
Fuel gauge
(3)
EXAMPLE
(2)
(2)
(4)
66RH115
(2) Information switch
(3) Trip meter switch
(4) Brightness control switch
75RM210
If the outside temperature nears freezing,
the message shown in the above illustration will appear on the display.
The information display shows the following information.
Display (A)
Clock
Display (B)
Thermometer
Display (C)
Warning and indicator messages /
Fuel consumption / Driving range /
Average speed / Driving time
81P31150
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, the message shown in the above illustration will
appear on the display for several seconds.
Some warning and indicator messages
may appear on the display when the ignition switch is in “ACC” or “LOCK” position,
or the ignition mode is ACC or LOCK
(OFF).
NOTE:
• The outside temperature indication is not
the actual outside temperature when
driving at low speed, or when stopped.
2-54
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Fuel consumption / Driving range /
Average speed / Driving time
When there are no warning or indicator
messages on the display (C), you can
select one of the following indications to
appear on the display: instantaneous fuel
consumption, average fuel consumption,
driving range, average speed, driving time
or no indication.
(f)
Instantaneous fuel consumption
Average fuel consumption
Driving range
Average speed
Driving time
No indication
To switch the display indication, push the
information switch (2) quickly.
NOTE:
The value of fuel consumption, driving
range and average speed shown on the
display are affected by the following conditions;
• Road condition
• Surrounding traffic condition
• Driving condition
• Vehicle condition
• A malfunction which causes the malfunction indicator light to come on or
blink
EXAMPLE
(a)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(b)
(c)
Instantaneous fuel consumption
The display shows instantaneous fuel consumption with a bar graph only when the
vehicle is moving.
(e)
(d)
66RH100
NOTE:
• The display does not show the bar graph
unless the vehicle is moving.
• Depending on the vehicle’s specification,
the fuel consumption units of initial setting are indicated as L/100km, km/L,
MPG (UK) or MPG (US).
• The indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is one of the
followings. No more than the maximum
value will be indicated on the display
even if the actual instantaneous fuel
consumption is higher.
– For L/100km setting: 30
– For km/L setting: 50
– For MPG (UK) setting: 80
– For MPG (US) setting: 60
• The indication on the display may be
delayed if fuel consumption is greatly
affected by driving conditions.
• The display shows estimated values.
Indications may not be the same as
actual values.
Average fuel consumption
If you selected average fuel consumption
the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel
consumption from previous driving when
the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON. Unless
you reset the value of average fuel consumption, the display indicates the value of
average fuel consumption based on the
average fuel consumption during previous
driving.
NOTE:
When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average
fuel consumption will be shown after driving for a period of time.
2-55
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
You can select when the value of average
fuel consumption is reset from among the
following three methods;
• Reset after refuel: the value of average
fuel consumption will be reset automatically by refueling.
• Reset with trip meter A: the value of
average fuel consumption will be reset
automatically by resetting trip meter A.
• Reset manually: the value of average
fuel consumption will be reset by pushing and holding the information switch
(2) when the display indicates the average fuel consumption.
To change when the value of average fuel
consumption is reset, refer to “Setting
mode” in this section.
NOTE:
If you add only a small amount of fuel
when you select “Reset after refuel”, the
average fuel consumption value may not
be reset.
Driving range
If you selected driving range the last time
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates
“---” for a few seconds and then indicates
the current driving range when the ignition
switch is turned to “ON” position or the
engine switch is pressed to change the
ignition mode to ON.
The driving range shown in the display is
the approximate distance you can drive
until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on
current driving conditions.
When the low fuel warning light comes on,
the display “---” will appear.
If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill
the fuel tank immediately regardless of the
value of driving range shown in the display.
As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving
condition, the value is different each time
you refuel.
NOTE:
• If you refuel when the ignition switch is in
“ON” position or the ignition mode is ON,
the driving range may not indicate the
correct value.
• When you reconnect the negative (–)
terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a
period of time.
Average Speed
If you selected average speed the last time
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates
the last value of average speed from previous driving when the ignition switch is
turned to “ON” position or the engine
switch is pressed to change the ignition
mode to ON. Unless you reset the value of
average speed, the display indicates the
value of average speed which includes
average speed during previous driving.
To reset the value of average speed, push
and hold the information switch (2) for a
while when the display indicates an average speed. The display shows “---” and
then indicates a new average speed after
driving for a short time.
NOTE:
When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the value of average
speed will be shown after driving for a
period of time.
Driving time
The display shows the total amount of driving time since the indication was reset.
• To reset the driving time to zero, push
and hold the information switch (2) for a
while when the display shows the driving
time.
NOTE:
When you reset the indication or reconnect
the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the
driving time will be shown after driving for a
while.
2-56
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Gear position / Gearshift indicator
The display (D) shows some of the following indications.
EXAMPLE
(6)
(5)
(7)
66RH116
(5) Gear position
(6) Manual mode indicator
(7) Drive mode indicator
Gear position
(for Auto Gear Shift models)
The display shows the current gear position (5).
NOTE:
For Auto Gear Shift models, when the
gearshift lever position and the gear position indication in the information display
are unmatched, the indication will blink and
the interior buzzer will sound. Refer to
“Auto Gear Shift” in the “OPERATING
YOUR VEHICLE” section for details.
Manual mode indicator
(for Auto Gear Shift models)
When you are using the manual mode, the
display shows the manual mode indicator
(6).
NOTE:
The indicated maximum value of the trip
meter is 9999.9. When you run past the
maximum value, the indicated value will
return to 0.0.
NOTE:
For Auto Gear Shift models, the manual
mode indicator will only appear when the
gearshift lever is in “M”.
Odometer
Drive mode indicator
(for Auto Gear Shift models)
When the gearshift lever is in “D”, the display shows the drive mode indicator (7).
For details on how to use the transaxle,
refer to “Using transaxle” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
Gearshift indicator (if equipped)
Refer to “Gearshift indicator” in the
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
Trip meter
The display (E) shows the trip meter.
The display (F) shows the odometer.
The odometer records the total distance
the vehicle has been driven.
NOTICE
Keep track of your odometer reading
and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services.
Increased wear or damage to certain
parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper
mileage intervals.
Fuel gauge
The display (G) shows the fuel gauge.
Refer to “Fuel gauge” in this section.
The trip meter can be used to measure the
distance traveled on short trips or between
fuel stops.
You can use trip meter A or trip meter B
independently.
To reset the trip meter to zero, push and
hold the trip meter switch (3) for a while.
2-57
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Setting mode
When the ignition switch is in “ON” position
or the ignition mode is ON and the vehicle
is stationary, you can enter the setting
mode of the information display by pushing
and holding the information switch (2) for
more than 3 seconds.
• To select the setting that you want to
change, push the brightness control
switch (4) up or down.
• To change the setting, push the information switch (2).
• To exit the setting mode, select “Back”
and push the information switch (2).
EXAMPLE
NOTE:
• If you push and hold the information
switch (2) to enter the setting mode
when the display (C) shows average fuel
consumption, average speed or driving
time, the value will be reset simultaneously. If you do not want to reset the
value, push the information switch
quickly to switch the indication of the display.
• If you turn the ignition switch, press the
engine switch or start to move the vehicle when the display is in the setting
mode, the setting mode will be canceled
automatically.
Distance unit
(Odometer / trip meter distance unit setting)
You can change the units in which odometer / trip meter / driving range distance is
displayed.
Fuel economy
(Fuel consumption unit setting)
You can change the units that fuel consumption is displayed in.
66RH156
NOTE:
The currently selected setting item is surrounded by a frame.
Language
You can change the language of the information display.
Fuel reset
(Average fuel consumption reset setting)
You can change when the value of average fuel consumption is reset.
Temperature (Temperature unit setting)
You can change the units that temperature
is displayed in.
NOTE:
When you change the units that temperature is displayed in, the automatic heating
and air conditioning system (if equipped)
temperature display units will be changed
automatically.
Clock setting (Adjusting the clock)
• To change the hour indication, push the
brightness control switch (4) up or down
repeatedly when the hour indication
appears as reversed color. To change
the hour indication quickly, push and
hold the brightness control switch (4). To
set the hour indication, push the information switch (2) and the minute indication
appears as reversed color.
• To change the minute indication, push
the brightness control switch (4) up or
down repeatedly when the minute indication appears as reversed color. To
change the minute indication quickly,
push and hold the brightness control
switch (4). To set the minute indication,
push the information switch (2).
You can also switch the time indication
between 12-hour and 24-hour format.
2-58
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Door lock (Door lock setting)
• Door unlock
– All Doors:
Unlock all doors by turning the key, or
operating the keyless entry system
transmitter, keyless push start system
remote controller or request switch
once.
– Driver Door:
Unlock all doors by turning the key, or
operating the keyless entry system
transmitter, keyless push start system
remote controller or request switch
twice (default setting).
• Auto lock
– Manual Lock:
Disable the automatic door locking
function.
– Speed Syncro:
Lock all doors when the vehicle speed
reaches 15 km/h (default setting).
• Auto unlock
– Syncro Off:
Disable the automatic door unlocking
function (default setting for the vehicle
with the keyless push start system).
– IG-OFF Sync:
Unlock all doors when the key is
pulled out from the ignition switch or
the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF) (default setting for the vehicle
without the keyless push start system).
• Alarm
You can turn off or on the siren sound
when the door(s) is(are) locked or
unlocked.
Lights (Light setting)
Lane change (Turn signal lights setting)
The turn signal and its indicator can be set
whether they flash three times even if you
return the turn signal control lever immediately after moving it.
Antitheft
(Security system setting)
You can switch the security system from
the enabled state to the disabled state, and
vice versa.
The state of the security system is shown
on the information display as follows:
• Mode A: Disabled state
• Mode D: Enabled state
(Shock sensor system setting)
You can change the on/off of the shock
sensor.
(Shock sensor P setting)
You can adjust the pre-warning sensitivity
of shock sensor.
(Shock sensor F setting)
You can adjust the full blast warning sensitivity of shock sensor.
Default (initialization setting)
If you select “YES” and push the information switch (2), all settings will be reinitialized.
Warning and indicator messages
The display shows warning and indicator
messages to let you know about certain
vehicle problems.
A tone may also sound to alert you.
If warning and indicator messages appear
on the display, follow the messages.
Master warning indicator light
80P0382
When the display shows warning and indicator messages, the master warning indicator light may also blink.
NOTE:
• When the problem that causes a message to appear is corrected, the message will disappear.
• If a message is displayed, and other
problems requiring a message occur, the
message for each of the problems will
be alternately displayed about every 5
seconds.
• When you push and hold the information
switch (2) for about 2 seconds while a
message is displayed, the message will
disappear temporarily. If the problem
that caused the message is not corrected, the message will appear again
after 5 seconds.
2-59
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator messages
All model
Warning and indicator
message
Master warning
indicator light
Sound
Cause and remedy
Blinks
(only while vehicle
is in motion)
Beep (one time from interior
buzzer; only while vehicle is
in motion)
A door or tailgate is not properly closed. If in
driving, stop the vehicle in a safe place and
close the door or tailgate properly. (#1)
Blinks
Continuous beep (from interior buzzer)
The parking brake is not released. Stop the
vehicle in a safe place and release the parking
brake.
Blinks
Continuous beep (from interior buzzer)
The headlights and/or the position lights are left
on. Turn them off.
75RM212
75RM268
61MM0A172
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-60
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator
message
Master warning
indicator light
Sound
Cause and remedy
Off
Beep (one time from interior
buzzer)
Fuel is low. Refill it immediately. (#1)
Off
Off
The road may be icy. Drive very carefully. (#1)
75RM213
66RM02004
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-61
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Vehicle with keyless push start system
Warning and indicator
message
Master warning
indicator light
Sound
Cause and remedy
Off
Off
This message is displayed when the ACC position is selected as the ignition mode. (#1)
Off
Off
The brake pedal (for Auto Gear Shift models) or
the clutch pedal (for manual transaxle models)
is depressed. Press the engine switch to start
the engine.
Blinks
Beep (one time from interior
buzzer)
There is a problem with the steering lock system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
61MM0A163
75RM214
61MM0A168
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-62
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator
message
Master warning
indicator light
Sound
Cause and remedy
Blinks
Beep (one time from interior
buzzer)
There is a problem with the keyless push start
system. Also, the vehicle battery voltage may
be decreased.
When the message is displayed even if you
start the engine with normal voltage of the vehicle battery, have your vehicle inspected by an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Blinks
By certain conditions, some
kind of sound you will hear
from interior and/or exterior
of the vehicle.
The remote controller may be outside the vehicle or its battery may have become discharged.
Locate the remote controller or touch the
engine switch with the remote controller.
If the message still appears, replace the remote
controller battery.
Off
Off
This message is displayed when the ON position is selected as the ignition mode. (#1)
75RM215
75RM216
75RM217
75RM218
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-63
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator
message
Master warning
indicator light
Sound
Cause and remedy
Blinks
Beep (one time from interior
buzzer)
The steering lock is not disengaged. While
lightly turning the steering wheel in both directions, press the engine switch again.
Off
Off
The remote controller battery is about to
become flat. Replace the battery. (#1)
Off
Off
The engine switch is pressed without depressing the brake and clutch pedals. Try again as
instructed by the message.
75RM219
75RM220
Manual transaxle
61MM0A166
(#1) This message will disappear for a while even if the problem that caused the message to appear is not corrected.
2-64
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator
message
Auto Gear Shift
Master warning
indicator light
Off
Sound
Off
Cause and remedy
The engine switch is pressed with the gearshift
lever in a position other than “N” and depressing the brake pedal. Try again as instructed by
message.
75RM322
2-65
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Information display
(Instrument cluster without
tachometer)
Fuel gauge
The display (A) shows the fuel gauge.
Refer to “Fuel gauge” in this section.
Gearshift indicator
EXAMPLE
(A)
(B)
(3)
The display (B) shows the gearshift indicator.
(C)
(D)
Refer to “Gearshift indicator” in the
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
EXAMPLE
66RH117
(3) Information display
(1)
(2)
75RM250
(1) Trip meter selector knob
(2) Indicator selector knob
When the ignition switch is in “ON” position, the information display shows the following information.
Display (A)
Fuel gauge
Display (B)
Gearshift indicator
Display (C)
Trip meter / Odometer / Fuel consumption /
Driving range
Display (D)
Clock
2-66
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Trip meter / Odometer /
Fuel consumption / Driving range
The display (C) shows one of the following
indications, trip meter A, trip meter B,
odometer, instantaneous fuel consumption, average fuel consumption or driving
range.
To switch the display indication (C), push
the trip meter selector knob (1) or the indicator selector knob (2) quickly.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
EXAMPLE
(a)
Trip meter A
Trip meter B
Odometer
Instantaneous fuel consumption
Average fuel consumption
Driving range
WARNING
(b)
If you attempt to adjust the display
while driving, you could lose control
of the vehicle.
Do not attempt to adjust the display
while driving.
(c)
NOTE:
• Indications will change when you push
and release a knob.
• The display shows estimated values.
Indications may not be the same as
actual values.
(d)
Trip meter
The trip meter can be used to measure the
distance traveled on short trips or between
fuel stops.
You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B
independently.
(e)
(f)
75RM368
Push the trip meter selector
knob (1).
Push the
knob (2).
indicator
To reset the trip meter to zero, push and
hold the trip meter selector knob (1) for a
while when the display shows the trip
meter.
selector
2-67
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
The indicated maximum value of the trip
meter is 9999.9. When you run past the
maximum value, the indicated value will
return to 0.0.
Odometer
The odometer records the total distance
the vehicle has been driven.
NOTICE
Keep track of your odometer reading
and check the maintenance schedule regularly for required services.
Increased wear or damage to certain
parts can result from failure to perform required services at the proper
mileage intervals.
Instantaneous fuel consumption
The display shows the value of instantaneous fuel consumption only when the
vehicle is moving.
NOTE:
• The display does not show the value
unless the vehicle is moving.
• Depending on the vehicle’s specification,
the fuel consumption units of initial setting are indicated as L/100km or km/L.
• The indicated maximum value of instantaneous fuel consumption is one of the
followings. No more than the maximum
value will be indicated on the display
even if the actual instantaneous fuel
consumption is higher.
– For L/100km setting: 30
– For km/L setting: 50
• The indication on the display may be
delayed if fuel consumption is greatly
affected by driving conditions.
• The display shows estimated values.
Indications may not be the same as
actual values.
• For “L/100km” or “km/L” setting, you can
change the units that instantaneous fuel
consumption is displayed in. Refer to
“Average fuel consumption” in this section.
Average fuel consumption
If you selected average fuel consumption
the last time you drove the vehicle, the display shows the last value of average fuel
consumption from previous driving when
the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position. Unless you reset the value of average
fuel consumption, the display indicates the
value of average fuel consumption which
includes average fuel consumption during
previous driving.
To reset the average fuel consumption to
zero, push and hold the indicator selector
knob (2) for a while when the display
shows the average fuel consumption.
NOTE:
When you reset the indication or reconnect
the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the
value of average fuel consumption will be
shown after driving for a while.
(For “L/100km” or “km/L” setting)
To change the unit of average fuel consumption, while pushing and holding the
trip meter selector knob (1), turn the indicator selector knob (2).
EXAMPLE
(Initial setting)
68PH02207
NOTE:
• When you change the units that average
fuel consumption is displayed in, the
instantaneous fuel consumption units will
be changed automatically.
• When you reconnect the negative (–)
terminal to the battery, the unit of the
average fuel consumption will be reinitialized. Change the unit again to your
preference.
2-68
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Driving range
If you selected driving range the last time
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates
“---” for a few seconds and then indicates
the current driving range when the ignition
switch is turned to “ON” position.
The driving range shown in the display is
the approximate distance you can drive
until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on
current driving conditions.
When the low fuel warning light comes on,
the display “---” will appear.
If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill
the fuel tank immediately regardless of the
value of driving range shown in the display.
As the driving range after refueling is calculated based on the most recent driving
condition, the value is different each time
you refuel.
NOTE:
• If you refuel when the ignition switch is in
“ON” position, the driving range may not
indicate the correct value.
• When you reconnect the negative (–)
terminal to the battery, the value of driving range will be shown after driving for a
while.
Clock
The display (D) shows the time.
To change the time indication:
1) Push the trip meter selector knob (1)
and the indicator selector knob (2)
together.
2) To change the hour indication, turn the
indicator selector knob (2) left or right
repeatedly when the hour indication
blinks. To change the hour indication
quickly, turn and hold the indicator
selector knob (2). To set the hour indication, push the indicator selector knob
(2) and the minute indication will blink.
3) To change the minute indication, turn
the indicator selector knob (2) left or
right repeatedly when the minute indication blinks. To change the minute
indication quickly, turn and hold the
indicator selector knob (2). To set the
minute indication, push the indicator
selector knob (2).
NOTE:
When you reconnect the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the clock indication will
be reinitialized. Change the indication
again to your preference.
WARNING
If you attempt to adjust the display
while driving, you could lose control
of the vehicle.
Do not attempt to adjust the display
while driving.
2-69
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Setting mode
In the setting mode, you can set up the following functions.
Indication
Functions
Time indication of clock “
”
Central door locking system “
”
Automatic door locking function “
”
Automatic door unlocking function “
Additional flashes of the turn signal “
Initialization setting “
”
Exit the setting mode “
”
”
”
2-70
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Turn the indicator selector knob
(2).
Push the
knob (2).
indicator
selector
NOTE:
Depending on vehicle’s specifications,
some items may not be displayed.
How to operate the setting mode:
1) When the ignition switch is in “ON”
position and the vehicle is stationary,
push the trip meter selector knob (1) to
switch the information display indication
(C) to the odometer.
2) Push and hold the indicator selector
knob (2) until the display shows
“
”.
3) Turn and/or push the indicator selector
knob (2) to select a function that you
want to set up according to the above
chart.
4) Turn and/or push the indicator selector
knob (2) to register settings of the following functions.
Time indication of clock “ ”
•
: 12-hour format (default setting)
•
: 24-hour format
Central door locking system “ ”
•
: Unlock all doors by turning
the key once
•
: Unlock all doors by turning
the key twice (default setting)
Automatic door locking function “ ”
•
: Disable the automatic door
locking function
•
: Lock all doors when the vehicle speed reaches 15 km/h
(default setting)
Automatic door unlocking function “ ”
•
: Disable the automatic door
unlocking function
•
: Unlock all doors when the key
is pulled out from the ignition
switch (default setting)
Initialization setting “
”
•
: Initialize all settings
EXAMPLE
75RM229
NOTE:
• As shown in the above illustration, “
”
indicates on the display of currently setting item.
• To go back to the higher level display
during operation, turn the indicator
selector knob (2) to display “
” or
“
” and then push the indicator
selector knob (2).
5) To exit the setting mode, switch the display to show “
” and then push the
indicator selector knob (2).
Additional flashes of the turn signal “ ”
•
: Turn signal flashes three
times after the turn signal
lever is returned (default setting)
•
: Disable the additional flashes
of turn signal
2-71
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Warning and indicator lights
NOTE:
If warning and indicator lights blink or
come on, the corresponding messages
may be shown on the information display.
Brake system warning light
brake, if the fluid level in the brake fluid
reservoir is adequate.
The light also comes on together with the
ABS warning light when the rear brake
force control function (proportioning valve
function) of the ABS system fails.
If the brake system warning light comes on
while you are driving the vehicle, it may
mean that there is something wrong with
the vehicle’s brake system.
If this happens:
1) Pull off the road and stop carefully.
82K170
Three different types of operations exist
depending on the vehicle’s specification.
• The light comes on briefly when the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or
the engine switch is pressed to change
the ignition mode to ON.
• The light comes on when the parking
brake is engaged with the ignition switch
in “ON” position or the ignition mode is
ON.
• The light comes on under either or both
of above two conditions.
The light also comes on when the fluid in
the brake fluid reservoir falls below the
specified level.
The light should go out after starting the
engine and fully releasing the parking
WARNING
Remember that stopping distance
may be longer, you may have to push
harder on the pedal, and the pedal
may go down farther than normal.
2) Test the brakes by carefully starting and
stopping the vehicle on the shoulder of
the road.
3) If you determine that it is safe, drive the
vehicle cautiously at low speed to the
nearest dealer for repairs or tow the
vehicle to the nearest dealer for repairs.
WARNING
If any of the following conditions
occur, you should immediately ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect the brake system.
• If the brake system warning light
does not go out after the engine
has been started and the parking
brake has been fully released.
• If the brake system warning light
does not come on when the ignition switch is turned to “ON” position or the engine switch is pressed
to change the ignition mode to ON.
• If the brake system warning light
comes on at any time during vehicle operation.
NOTE:
Because the brake system is self-adjusting, the fluid level will drop as the brake
pads become worn. Replenishing the
brake fluid reservoir is considered normal
periodic maintenance.
NOTE:
Parking brake reminder buzzer
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to release the parking brake if you
start the vehicle without releasing the parking brake. Make sure that the parking
brake is fully released and the brake system warning light turns off.
2-72
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) warning light
the rear brake force control function and
the anti-lock function of the ABS system.
If one of the above occurs, have the system inspected by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
If the ABS becomes inoperative, the brake
system will function as an ordinary brake
system that does not have this ABS system.
65D529
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on briefly so you can check that the
light is working.
If the light stays on or comes on when driving, there may be something wrong with
the ABS.
If this happens:
1) Pull off the road and stop carefully.
2) Turn the ignition switch to “LOCK” or
change the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF) by pressing the engine switch
and then start the engine again.
If the warning light comes on briefly and
then turns off, the system is normal. If the
warning light still stays on, something is
wrong with the system.
If the light and the brake system warning
light stay on or come on simultaneously
when driving, your ABS system is
equipped with the rear brake force control
function (proportioning valve function) and
there may be something wrong with both
For details of ABS system, refer to “Antilock brake system (ABS)” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.
rised Maruti Suzuki workshop before you
drive the vehicle again.
NOTICE
• If you operate the engine with this
light on, severe engine damage can
result.
• Do not rely on the oil pressure light
to indicate the need to add oil. Periodically check the engine oil level.
Charging light
Oil pressure light
50G052
50G051
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on. When the engine is started, the
light goes out. The light will come on and
remain on if there is insufficient oil pressure. If the light comes on when driving,
pull off the road as soon as you can and
stop the engine.
Check the oil level and add oil if necessary.
If there is enough oil, the lubrication system should be inspected by your autho-
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on. When the engine is started, the
light goes out. The light will come on and
remain on if there is something wrong with
the battery charging system. If the light
comes on when the engine is running, the
charging system should be inspected
immediately by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
2-73
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Driver’s seat belt reminder light
WARNING
60G049
When the driver does not buckle his or her
seat belt, this light will come on and/or
blink.
For details of the seat belt reminder, refer
to “Seat belts and child restraint systems”
in this section.
If AIR BAG light does not blink or
come on briefly when the ignition
switch is turned to “ON” position or
the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON,
stays on for more than 10 seconds,
or comes on while driving, the air bag
system or the seat belt pretensioner
system may not work properly. Have
both systems inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Malfunction indicator light
If the malfunction indicator light comes on
or blinks when the engine is running, there
is a damage in the emission control system.
Bring the vehicle to your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop to have the damage
fixed.
Also, if this light comes on when the
engine is running, there is a problem with
the Auto Gear Shift system. Ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the system inspected.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive the vehicle when
the malfunction indicator light is on
or blinking can cause permanent
damage to the vehicle’s emission
control system, and can affect fuel
economy and driveability.
“AIR BAG” light
65D530
63J030
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
blinks or comes on for several seconds so
you can check that the light is working.
The light will come on and stay on if there
is a problem in the air bag system or the
seat belt pretensioner system.
Your vehicle has a computer-controlled
emission control system. A malfunction
indicator light is provided on the instrument
cluster to indicate when it is necessary to
have the emission control system serviced.
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on. When the engine is started, the
light goes out.
2-74
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Transaxle warning light
(if equipped)
Immobilizer / keyless push start
system warning light
Open door warning light
54G391
80J219
80JM122
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on for several seconds so you can
check that the light is working.
If this light comes on when the engine is running, there is a problem with the Auto Gear
Shift system. Ask your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop to have the system
inspected.
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on briefly so you can check that the
light is working.
NOTE:
If the Auto Gear Shift clutch temperature
becomes too high, this light will blink. Stop
the vehicle in a safe place and let the system cool down.
If this light stays on, there is a problem with
the system or the steering lock cannot be
released. If this happens, press the engine
switch, turning the steering wheel to the
right or left. If this light still stays on, ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the system inspected.
This light remains on until all doors (including the tailgate) are completely closed.
If any door (including the tailgate) is open
when the vehicle is moving, a ding sounds
to remind you to close all doors completely.
Low fuel warning light
54G343
If this light comes on, fill the fuel tank
immediately.
When this light comes on, a ding sounds
once to remind you to fill the fuel.
If you do not fill the fuel, a ding sounds
every time when the ignition switch is
turned to “ON” position or the engine
switch is pressed to change the ignition
mode to ON.
2-75
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTE:
The activation point of this light varies
depending on road conditions (for example, slope or curve) and driving conditions
because of fuel moving in the tank.
Electric power steering light
79J039
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on. When the engine is started, the
light goes out.
If this light comes on while driving, the
power steering system may not work properly. Have the system inspected by your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
NOTE:
The following steering wheel operations
may gradually take more effort while parking or driving at a very low speed. This is
not a malfunction of the steering system,
but the power steering control system limits the power assist in order to prevent it
from overheating.
• The steering wheel is operated very
often.
• The steering wheel is kept in a fully
turned position for a long while.
When the power steering control system
cools down, the power steering system will
return to its original condition.
However, repeating these operations could
cause damage to the power steering system.
NOTE:
If the power steering system does not work
properly, it will require greater effort to
steer, but you still will be able to steer.
NOTE:
If the steering is operated, you may hear
noise caused by electric power steering
operation. This is normal and indicates that
the power steering system works properly.
Engine coolant temperature
warning light
68PH00274
When the ignition switch is turned to the
“ON” position or the engine switch is
pressed to change the ignition mode “ON”,
this light comes on briefly so you can
check that the light is working.
This indicator has two following functions.
Low engine coolant temperature light
(Blue color)
This light stays on while the engine is still
cold and goes off when the engine has
warmed up.
If this light blinks, there is a problem with
the system. Have your vehicle inspected
by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
High engine coolant temperature warning light (Red color)
If this light blinks while driving, it means the
engine is running hot. Avoid driving conditions that may lead to actual overheating. If
the light stays on without blinking, then the
engine is overheating. Follow the instruc-
2-76
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
tions in the “Engine trouble: Overheating”
of “EMERGENCY SERVICE” section.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive the vehicle when
engine overheating is indicated can
result in severe engine damage.
turn on the hazard warning switch, both
arrows will flash along with all of the turn
signal lights.
Glow plug indicator light
(For diesel engine model)
Main beam (high beam) indicator
light
Front fog light indicator light
(if equipped)
60A543
50G056
This indicator comes on when headlight
main beams (high beams) are turned on.
82PH045
Illumination indicator light
If the coolant temperature is cool enough,
this light comes on when the ignition
switch is turned to “ON” position or the
engine switch is pressed to change the
ignition mode to ON and goes out when
the glow plug is heated enough for engine
starting.
Fuel filter warning light
(For diesel engine model)
The front fog light indicator light comes on
when the front fog light operates.
Turn signal indicators
64J045
This indicator light comes on while the
position lights, tail light and/or the headlights are on.
50G055
When you turn on the left or right turn signals, the corresponding green arrow on the
instrument cluster will flash along with the
respective turn signal lights. When you
60A541
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on for several seconds so you can
check that the light is working.
If the light comes on when driving, it is possible that water may be in the fuel filter.
2-77
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Drain water as soon as possible. Have
your vehicle inspected by an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Depress brake pedal indicator
(if equipped)
Lighting control lever
Lighting operation
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
76MH0A047
Refer to “Auto Gear Shift” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section for details.
65D611
Master warning indicator light
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
80P0382
When the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to ON, this light
comes on briefly so you can check that the
light is working.
When the information display shows warning and indicator messages, this indicator
light may also blink.
For details, refer to “Information display
(instrument cluster with tachometer)” in
this section.
66RH032
To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob
on the end of the lever. There are three
positions:
OFF
All lights are off.
Front position lights, tail lights, license
plate light and instrument lights are on, but
headlights are off.
Front position lights, tail lights, license
plate light, instrument lights and headlights
are on.
2-78
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Light reminder buzzer
The interior buzzer continuously beeps if
you open the driver’s door without turning
off the headlights and position lights. This
function is triggered under the following
condition:
The headlights and/or position lights are
on even after the ignition switch is turned
off, or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode to LOCK (OFF).
EXAMPLE
Front fog light switch
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
The buzzer stops sounding when you turn
off the headlights and position lights.
66RH033
With the headlights on, push the lever forward to switch to the high beams (main
beams) or pull the lever toward you to
switch to the low beams. When the high
beams (main beams) are on, a light on the
instrument cluster will come on. To
momentarily activate the high beams (main
beams) as a passing signal, pull the lever
slightly toward you and release it when you
have completed the signal.
NOTE:
A message is indicated on the information
display in the instrument cluster with
tachometer while the buzzer is sounding.
Daytime running light (D.R.L.)
system (if equipped)
When the engine is started, this system
turns on the daytime running lights.
NOTICE
Conditions for D.R.L. system operation
1) The engine is running.
2) Headlights and front fog light (if
equipped) are off.
Do not leave the headlamp ON in any
position when the engine is not running, or the battery will discharge
rapidly.
NOTE:
Brightness of the daytime running lights is
different from the brightness of the position
lights, but it is not a malfunction.
66RH034
To turn the front fog light on, twist the knob
as shown in the illustration with the position lights, tail lights and/or the headlights
are on. When the front fog light is on, an
indicator light on the instrument cluster will
come on.
NOTE:
In some countries, the lighting operation
may be different from the above description according to local regulations.
2-79
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Headlight leveling switch
Vehicle Load
Condition
EXAMPLE
75RM008
Level the headlight beam according to the
load condition of your vehicle by turning
this switch. The chart below shows the
appropriate switch position for different
vehicle load conditions.
Switch
Position
Driver only
0
Driver + 1 passenger
(in front seat)
0
Driver + 4 passengers,
no cargo
1
Driver + 4 passengers,
cargo added
2
Driver + full cargo
3
Turn signal control lever
EXAMPLE
65D611
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
2-80
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Turn signal operation
With the ignition switch in “ON” position or
the ignition mode ON, move the lever
upward or downward to activate the left or
right turn signals respectively.
Hazard warning switch
Lane change signal
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
Normal turn signal
EXAMPLE
66RH036
66RH035
Move the lever all the way upward or
downward to signal. When the turn is completed, the signal will cancel and the lever
will return to its normal position.
Move the lever partway upward or downward to turn left or right and hold the lever
in the moved position.
• The turn signal and its indicator flash
while the lever is held at the moved position.
The turn signal and its indicator flash 3
times even if you return the lever immediately after moving it.
NOTE:
The turn signal and its indicator can be set
whether they flash 3 times after the turn
signal lever is returned via the information
display. Refer to “Information display” in
this section.
62R0138
Push in the hazard warning switch to activate the hazard warning lights. All turn signal lights and both turn signal indicators
will flash simultaneously. To turn off the
lights, push the switch again.
Use the hazard warning lights to warn
other drivers of possible risk of traffic hazard when you park your vehicle in case of
emergency.
NOTE:
You can customize the setting for the number of flashing times of the turn signal and
its indicator (1 to 4 times). Please ask an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for the
customization.
2-81
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Windshield wiper and washer
lever
EXAMPLE
57L21128
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
Wiper and washer operation
When the ignition switch is in “ON” position
or the ignition mode is ON, you can use
the wiper/washer lever or switch (if
equipped).
When the wipers are under heavy load
such as covered by snow, the breaker will
be activated and the wipers will stop operating to protect the wiper motor from overheating.
If the wiper stops during operation, do the
following methods.
1) Stop the vehicle in a safe place, and
turn the engine off.
2) Move the wiper lever and switch to
“OFF” position.
3) Remove obstacles such as snow on the
wipers.
4) After a while, when the temperature of
the wiper motor becomes low enough,
the breaker will be reset automatically
and the wipers will be able to use.
If you cannot use the wipers after a while,
there may be another problem. Ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the wipers inspected.
Windshield wipers
EXAMPLE
MIST
OFF
INT
LO
HI
66RH037
To turn the windshield wipers on, move the
lever down to one of the three operating
positions. In “INT” position, the wipers
operate intermittently. The “INT” position is
very convenient for driving in mist or light
rain. In “LO” position, the wipers operate at
a steady low speed. In “HI” position, the
wipers operate at a steady high speed. To
turn off the wipers, move the lever back to
“OFF” position.
Move the lever up and hold it to “MIST”
position, the windshield wipers will turn on
continuously at low speed.
2-82
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Windshield washer
NOTICE
EXAMPLE
66RH038
To spray windshield washer fluid, pull the
lever toward you. The windshield wipers
will automatically turn on at low speed if
they are not already on and your vehicle is
equipped with “INT” position.
WARNING
• To prevent windshield icing in cold
weather, turn on the defroster to
heat the windshield before and
during windshield washer use.
• Do not use radiator antifreeze in
the windshield washer reservoir. It
can severely impair visibility when
sprayed on the windshield, and can
also damage your vehicle’s paint.
To help prevent damage to the windshield wiper and washer system
components, you should take the following precautions:
• Do not continue to hold in the lever
when there is no windshield
washer fluid being sprayed or the
washer motor can be damaged.
• Do not attempt to remove dirt from
a dry windshield with the wipers or
you can damage the windshield
and the wiper blades. Always wet
the windshield with washer fluid
before operating the wipers.
• Clear ice or packed snow from the
wiper blades before using the wipers.
• Check the washer fluid level regularly. Make sure it often when the
weather is bad.
• Only fill the washer fluid reservoir
3/4 full during cold weather to allow
room for expansion if the temperature falls low enough to freeze the
solution.
Rear window wiper/washer switch
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Washer
Wiper
66RH039
To turn the rear wiper on, twist the rear
wiper switch on the end of the lever forward to “ON” position. To turn the rear
wiper off, twist the switch rearward to
“OFF” position.
With the rear wiper in “OFF” position, twist
the switch rearward and hold it there to
spray window washer fluid.
With the rear wiper in “ON” position, turn
the switch forward and hold it there to
spray window washer fluid.
2-83
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
NOTICE
Tilt steering lock lever
Horn
EXAMPLE
Clear ice or snow from the rear window and rear wiper blade before
using the rear wiper. Accumulated
ice or snow could prevent the wiper
blade from moving, causing damage
to the wiper motor.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
75RM044
75RM045
(1) LOCK
(2) UNLOCK
The lock lever is located under the steering
column. To adjust the steering wheel
height:
Press the horn button of the steering wheel
to sound the horn. The horn will sound with
the ignition switch in any position or any
ignition mode.
1) Push down the lock lever to unlock the
steering column.
2) Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
height and lock the steering column by
pulling up the lock lever.
3) Try moving the steering wheel up and
down to check that it is securely locked
in position.
WARNING
Never attempt to adjust the steering
wheel while the vehicle is moving or
you could lose control of the vehicle.
2-84
66RH0-74E
BEFORE DRIVING
Heated rear window switch
(if equipped)
Type 1
EXAMPLE
When the rear window is misted, push this
switch (1) to clear the window.
An indicator light will be lit when the defogger is on. The defogger will work only
when the engine is running. To turn off the
defogger, push the switch (1) again.
NOTICE
The heated rear window uses a large
amount of electricity. Turn off the
switch after the window has become
clear.
(1)
66RH118
Type 2
EXAMPLE
NOTE:
• The defogger will work only when the
engine is running.
• The defogger will automatically turn off
after the defogger remains on for 15 minutes to prevent discharging of the battery.
(1)
66RH119
2-85
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
60G408
Exhaust gas warning .......................................................... 3-1
Daily inspection checklist .................................................. 3-1
Engine oil consumption ..................................................... 3-2
3
Ignition switch
(vehicle without keyless push start system) .................... 3-3
Engine switch
(vehicle with keyless push start system) .......................... 3-5
Keyless push start system (if equipped) .......................... 3-6
Parking brake lever ............................................................. 3-9
Pedal ..................................................................................... 3-10
Starting the engine
(vehicle without keyless push start system) .................... 3-11
Starting the engine
(vehicle with keyless push start system) .......................... 3-13
Using the transaxle ............................................................. 3-16
Gearshift indicator (if equipped) ........................................ 3-27
Parking sensors (if equipped) ............................................ 3-28
Rearview camera (if equipped) .......................................... 3-32
Braking ................................................................................. 3-35
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Exhaust gas warning
WARNING
EXAMPLE
52D334
WARNING
Avoid breathing exhaust gases.
Exhaust gases contain carbon monoxide, a potentially lethal gas that is
colorless and odorless. Since carbon
monoxide is difficult to detect by
itself, take the following precautions
to help prevent carbon monoxide
from entering your vehicle.
• Do not leave the engine running in
garages or other confined areas.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• Do not park with the engine running for a long period of time, even
in an open area. If it is necessary to
sit for a short time in a parked vehicle with the engine running, make
sure that the air intake selector is
set to FRESH AIR and the blower is
at high speed.
• Avoid operating the vehicle with
the tailgate or trunk open. If it is
necessary to do so, make sure that
the sunroof (if equipped) and all
windows are closed, and the
blower is at high speed with the air
intake selector set to FRESH AIR.
• To allow proper operation of your
vehicle’s ventilation system, keep
the air inlet grill in front of the windshield clear of snow, leaves or
other obstructions at all times.
• Keep the exhaust tailpipe area clear
of snow and other material to help
reduce the buildup of exhaust
gases under the vehicle. This is
particularly important when parked
in blizzard conditions.
• Have the exhaust system inspected
periodically for damage and leakage. Any damage or leakage
should be repaired immediately.
Daily inspection checklist
Before driving
EXAMPLE
60A187S
1) Make sure that windows, mirrors, lights
and reflectors are clean and unobstructed.
2) Visually check the tires for the following
points:
– the depth of the tread groove
– abnormal wear, cracks and damage
– loose wheel nuts
– existence of foreign material such as
nails, stones, etc.
Refer to “Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section for details.
3) Look for fluid and oil leakage.
3-1
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE:
It is normal for water to drip from the air
conditioning system after use.
4) Make sure that the hood is fully closed
and latched.
5) Check the headlights, turn signal lights,
brake lights and horn for proper operation.
6) Adjust the seat and head restraint (if
equipped).
7) Check the brake pedal and the parking
brake lever.
8) Adjust the mirrors.
9) Check that you and all passengers
have properly fastened your seat belts.
10)Check that all warning lights come on
as the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed
to change the ignition mode to ON.
11)Check all gauges.
12)Check that the brake system warning
light turns off when the parking brake is
released.
Once a week, or each time you fill your fuel
tank, perform the following under-hood
checks:
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
Engine oil level
Coolant level
Brake fluid level
Battery solution level
Windshield washer fluid level
Hood latch operation
Pull the hood release handle inside the
vehicle. Make sure that you cannot
open the hood all the way without
releasing the secondary latch. Close
the hood securely after checking for
proper latch operation. See the item “All
latches, hinges and locks” of “Chassis,
body and others” in “Maintenance
schedule” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section for lubrication
schedule.
WARNING
Make sure that the hood is fully
closed and latched before driving. If
it is not, it can fly up unexpectedly
during driving, obstructing your view
and resulting in an accident.
Once a month, or each time you fill your
fuel tank, check the tire pressure using a
tire pressure gauge. Also check the tire
pressure of the spare tire.
Engine oil consumption
It is normal for the engine to consume
some engine oil during normal vehicle
operation.
The amount of engine oil consumption
depends on viscosity and quality of the oil
and your driving conditions.
More oil is consumed during high-speed
driving and when there is frequent acceleration and deceleration. Under high loads,
your engine also will consume more oil.
A new engine also consumes more oil,
since its pistons, piston rings and cylinder
walls have not yet become conditioned.
New engines reach the normal level of oil
consumption only after approximately
5000 km driving.
Oil consumption:
Max. 1.0 L per 1000 km
When judging the amount of oil consumption, note that the oil may become diluted
and it is difficult to judge the accurate oil
level.
As an example, if a vehicle is used for
repeated short trips, and consumes a normal amount of oil, the dipstick may not
show any drop in the oil level at all, even
after 1000 km or more of driving. This is
because the oil gradually becomes diluted
with fuel or moisture, making it appear that
the oil level has not changed.
3-2
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
You should also be aware that the diluting
ingredients evaporate out when the vehicle
is subsequently driven at high speeds,
such as on an expressway, making it
appear that oil is excessively consumed
after high-speed driving.
Ignition switch (vehicle
without keyless push start
system)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
68PH00310
The ignition switch has the following four
positions:
65D611
WARNING
To avoid possible injury, do not operate controls by reaching through the
steering wheel.
LOCK
This is the normal parking position. It is the
only position in which the key can be
removed.
3-3
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Turn to “LOCK”
START
This is the position for starting the engine
using the starter motor. The key should be
released from this position as soon as the
engine starts.
Ignition key reminder
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the
ignition switch when the driver’s door is
opened.
Push
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
60G033
You must push in the key to turn it to
“LOCK” position. It locks the ignition, and
prevents normal use of the steering wheel
after the key is removed.
NOTICE
To release the steering lock, insert the key
and turn it clockwise to one of the other
positions. If you have trouble turning the
key to unlock the steering, try turning the
steering wheel slightly to the right or left
while turning the key.
ACC
Accessories such as the radio can operate, but the engine is off.
ON
This is the normal operating position. All
electrical systems are on.
WARNING
(Continued)
• Always return the ignition switch to
“LOCK” position and remove the
ignition key when leaving the vehicle even only for a short time. Also
do not leave children alone in a
parked vehicle. Unattended children could cause accidental movement of the vehicle or could tamper
with power windows or power sunroof. They also could suffer from
heat stroke in warm or hot weather.
These could result in severe injury
or even death.
81A297S
WARNING
• Never return the ignition switch to
“LOCK” position and remove the
ignition key while the vehicle is
moving. The steering wheel will
lock and you will not be able to
steer the vehicle.
(Continued)
• Do not use the starter motor for
more than 12 seconds at a time. If
the engine does not start, wait 15
seconds before trying again. If the
engine does not start after several
attempts, make sure the fuel and
ignition systems or consult your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
• Do not leave the ignition switch in
“ON” position if the engine is not
running as the battery will discharge.
3-4
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Engine switch (vehicle with
keyless push start system)
EXAMPLE
ON
• With the engine off
You can use such electric equipment as
the power windows and wipers with the
engine off. When this ignition mode is
selected by pressing the engine switch,
the information display in the instrument
cluster shows the following message:
“ON” IGNITION SWITCH POSITION.
• With the engine on
All electric equipment is operational. The
vehicle can be driven when you have
selected this ignition mode by pressing
the engine switch.
66RH040
LOCK (OFF)
This mode is for parking the vehicle. When
this mode is selected by pressing the
engine switch and then any door (including
the tailgate) is opened or closed, the steering will be locked automatically.
ACC
Press the engine switch to select this ignition mode to use such electric equipment
as the audio system, outside rearview mirrors and accessory socket with the engine
off. When this position is selected, the
information display in the instrument cluster shows the following message: “ACC”
IGNITION SWITCH POSITION. Refer to
“Information display” in the “BEFORE
DRIVING” section for details.
START
Manual transaxle – Provided you have the
keyless push start system remote controller with you, the engine automatically
starts when you press the engine switch to
select this ignition mode after shifting to
“N” (Neutral) and depressing the brake and
clutch pedals.
NOTE:
You do not need to keep the engine switch
pressed to start the engine.
NOTICE
Do not leave the engine switch in
ACC or ON mode when the engine is
not running. Avoid using the radio or
other electric accessories for a long
time when the engine switch is in
ACC or ON mode when the engine is
not running, otherwise the battery
may discharge.
NOTE:
In the presence of strong radio signals or
noise, you may not be able to change the
ignition mode to ACC or ON or to start the
engine using the engine switch. In this
case, the information display in the instrument cluster will show the following message: KEY FOB NOT DETECTED.
Auto Gear Shift – Provided you have the
keyless push start system remote controller with you, the engine automatically
starts when you press the engine switch to
select this ignition mode after shifting to
“N” (Neutral) and depressing the brake
pedal.
3-5
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Unreleased steering lock warning
If the steering lock remains engaged when
you press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON, the information display in the instrument cluster shows the
message: “TRN. STEERING WHEEL TO
RELEASE LOCK”. Refer to “Information
display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details.
NOTE:
The steering lock may not be released and
the immobilizer/keyless push start system
warning light turns on if some load is acting
on the steering wheel. If this happens, turn
the steering wheel to the right or left to
relieve it from the load before you press
the engine switch again to change to the
desired ignition mode.
Keyless push start system
(if equipped)
Provided the keyless push start system
remote controller is within the interior workable area (refer to the related explanation
in this section), you can use the engine
switch for starting the engine and selecting
an ignition mode (ACC or ON). In addition,
the following functions can be used:
• Keyless entry function. Refer to “Keyless
push start system remote controller /
keyless entry system transmitter” in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section for details.
• Locking and unlocking doors (including
the tailgate) using a request switch.
Refer to “Keyless push start system
remote controller / keyless entry system
transmitter” in the “BEFORE DRIVING”
section for details.
• Immobilizer (anti-theft) function. Refer to
“Immobilizer system” in the “BEFORE
DRIVING” section for details.
Engine switch illumination
The engine switch is illuminated (lit) in the
following situations:
• When the engine is off and the driver’s
door is open, or for 15 seconds after the
driver’s door is closed. The illumination
will fade out after 15 seconds passed.
• When the engine is off and the position
lights are on. The illumination will go out
when the position lights are turned off.
• When the engine is on and the position
lights and/or the headlights are on. The
illumination will go out when the position
lights are turned off.
EXAMPLE
82K253
NOTE:
To save the battery, the illumination will be
automatically turned off when both of the
following conditions are simultaneously
met:
• The headlights and position lights are
turned off.
• 15 minutes has elapsed since opening
the driver’s door.
3-6
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Selection of ignition modes
Press the engine switch to select ACC or
ON mode as follows when you use an
electric accessory or check the operation
of instruments without running the engine.
1) Bring the keyless push start system
remote controller with you and sit in the
driver’s seat.
2) Manual transaxle – Without depressing
the clutch pedal, press the engine
switch (1).
Auto Gear Shift – Without depressing
the brake pedal, press the engine
switch (1).
Every time you press the engine switch,
the ignition mode changes as follows.
EXAMPLE
(OFF)
(Audio equipment)
If the master warning indicator light
blinks and the ignition modes cannot
be selected
Your keyless push start system remote controller may not be sensed as being within the
interior workable area (refer to the related
explanation in this section). Try again after
checking that you have the remote controller
with you. If the ignition modes still cannot be
selected, the battery of the remote controller
may be discharged. To select an ignition
mode, you must then use the following
method:
EXAMPLE
68PH00322
EXAMPLE
NOTE:
When selecting the ignition modes, the
information display in the instrument cluster shows certain messages. Refer to
“Information display” in “BEFORE DRIVING” section for details.
(1)
(1)
(2)
68PH00304
82K254
1) Without depressing the brake pedal
and the clutch pedal, push the engine
switch (1).
2) The master warning indicator light in
the instrument cluster blinks and the
message “PLACE KEY FOB ON
START SWITCH” appears on the information display within about 10 seconds. Touch the engine switch with
3-7
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
LOCK button end of remote controller
(2) for about 2 seconds.
NOTE:
• If you still cannot select the ignition
modes, there may be some problem with
the keyless push start system. Contact
an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
for an inspection of the system.
• The immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light will come on for about
5 seconds while the master warning indicator light is blinking. In addition, the
information display in the instrument
cluster will show a message during this
time. Refer to “Information display” in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section for details.
• You may customize the system to cause
the interior buzzer to sound once for
warning that remote controller is out of
sensing range. To incorporate this customization, please contact an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
• If the battery of the remote controller is
about to become completely discharged,
the corresponding message will appear
on the information display when you
press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON. Refer to “Information display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING”
section for details. For details on replacing the battery, refer to “Keyless push
start system remote controller / keyless
entry system transmitter” in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section.
REMOTE CONTROLLER OUTSIDE
warning
EXAMPLE
When either of the conditions described
below is met, the system issues a
REMOTE CONTROLLER OUTSIDE warning by sounding the interior and exterior
buzzers. At the same time, the immobilizer/keyless push start system warning
light comes on and the master warning
indicator light blinks.
• Any door is opened and then closed
while the remote controller is not inside
the vehicle and the engine is running or
the ignition mode has been changed to
ACC or ON by pressing the engine
switch.
• The remote controller is not inside the
vehicle when you attempt to start the
engine after changing the ignition mode
to ACC or ON by pressing the engine
switch.
(1)
(2)
75RM048
(1) Immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light (blinks)
(2) Master warning indicator light (blinks)
NOTE:
• If the warning is given, locate the remote
controller as soon as possible.
• Any attempt to start the engine will fail
while the warning is active. The message appearing on the information display in the instrument cluster will also
indicate this condition. Refer to “Information display” in the “BEFORE DRIVING”
section for details.
• Normally, the immobilizer/keyless push
start system warning light should go out
and the master warning indicator light
should stop blinking shortly after the
remote controller is brought back inside
the vehicle. If they remain lit and blinking,
change the ignition mode to LOCK (OFF)
3-8
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
by pressing the engine switch and then
perform the engine starting operation.
Refer to “Starting engine (vehicle with keyless push start system)” in this section.
• Always keep the remote controller with
you as the driver.
Interior workable area for engine
starting
EXAMPLE
(1)
54P000373
(1) Interior workable area
The interior workable area for these functions is defined as all the interior spaces
except for the space above the instrument
panel.
NOTE:
• Even when the remote controller is in the
interior workable area, if it is in any of the
following conditions, you may not be
able to start the engine or select the ignition modes, and the REMOTE CONTROLLER OUTSIDE warning may be
given.
– The remote controller’s battery is low.
– The remote controller is affected by
strong radio signals or noise.
– The remote controller is in contact with
or covered by a metallic object.
– The remote controller is in stowage
such as the glove box or a door
pocket.
– The remote controller is in the sun
visor pocket or on the floor.
• Even when the remote controller is outside the interior workable area, if it is in
any of the following conditions, you may
be able to start the engine or select the
ignition mode. The REMOTE CONTROLLER OUTSIDE warning may not
be given at that time.
– The remote controller is outside the
vehicle but very close to a door.
– The remote controller is on the instrument panel.
Parking brake lever
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(3)
68PHM3001
(1) To set
(2) To release
(3) To release
The parking brake lever is located between
the seats. To set the parking brake, hold
the brake pedal down and pull the parking
brake lever all the way up. To release the
parking brake, hold the brake pedal down,
pull up slightly on the parking brake lever,
push the button on the end of the lever
with your thumb, and lower the lever to its
original position.
3-9
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
• Never drive your vehicle with the
parking brake on: rear brake effectiveness can be reduced from overheating, brake life may be
shortened, or permanent brake
damage may result.
• If the parking brake does not hold
the vehicle securely or does not
fully release, have your vehicle
inspected immediately by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
WARNING
Always set the parking brake fully
before leaving your vehicle or it may
move, causing injury or damage.
When parking, make sure that the
gearshift lever is in one of the following positions;
• 1st gear or “R” (Reverse) for manual transaxle vehicles.
• “D”, “M” or “R” for Auto Gear Shift
vehicles. Also, make sure the
instrument cluster to make sure
that the transaxle is engaged in “1”
or “R” position.
Remember,
even
though
the
transaxle is in gear, you must set the
parking brake fully.
WARNING
When parking the vehicle in
extremely cold weather, the following
procedure should be used:
1) Set the parking brake.
2) Manual transaxle – turn off the
engine, then shift into reverse or
first gear.
Auto Gear Shift – shift into “D”,
“M” or “R” and make sure the gear
position indicator in the instrument cluster to make sure that the
transaxle is engaged in “1” or “R”
position, then turn off the engine.
3) Get out of the vehicle and put
chocks under the wheels.
4) Release the parking brake.
When you return to your vehicle,
first set the parking brake, and
then remove the wheel chocks.
NOTE:
(For Auto Gear Shift Model)
For details on how to use the gearshift
lever to park the vehicle, refer to “Parking”
in “Auto Gear Shift” in this section.
Parking brake reminder buzzer
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind
you to release the parking brake if you
start the vehicle without releasing the parking brake. Make sure that the parking
brake is fully released and the brake system warning light turns off.
Pedal
Manual transaxle
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(3)
80J2121
Auto Gear Shift
EXAMPLE
(2)
(3)
80J2122
3-10
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Clutch pedal (1)
A clutch pedal is used to disengage the
drive to the wheels when starting the
engine, stopping, or shifting the gearshift
lever. Depressing the pedal disengages
the clutch.
WARNING
Do not drive with your foot resting on
the clutch pedal. It could result in
excessive clutch wear, clutch damage, or unexpected loss of engine
braking.
Brake pedal (2)
Your MARUTI SUZUKI vehicle is equipped
with front disc brakes and rear drum
brakes. Depressing a brake pedal applies
both sets of brakes.
You may hear occasional brake squeal
when you apply the brakes. This is a normal condition caused by environmental
factors such as cold, wet, snow, etc.
WARNING
If brake squeal is excessive and
occurs each time the brakes are
applied, you should have the brakes
checked by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
WARNING
Do not apply brakes continuously or
rest your foot on the brake pedal.
This will result in overheating of the
brakes which could cause unpredictable braking action, longer stopping
distances, or permanent brake damage.
Starting the engine (vehicle
without keyless push start
system)
Before starting the engine
MT
Accelerator pedal (3)
An accelerator pedal controls the speed of
the engine. Depressing the accelerator
pedal increases power output and speed.
AGS
EXAMPLE
66RH041
1) Make sure that the parking brake is set
fully.
2) Manual transaxle – Shift into “N” (Neutral) and depress the clutch pedal all
the way to the floor. Hold the clutch
pedal while starting the engine.
Auto Gear Shift – Shift into “N” (Neutral)
and depress the brake pedal. Hold the
brake pedal while starting the engine.
NOTE:
For Auto Gear Shift vehicles, if the engine
cannot be started, make sure the gearshift
lever is in “N” before restarting the engine.
3-11
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
Make sure that the parking brake is
set fully and the transaxle is in Neutral before attempting to start the
engine.
Starting a cold and warm engine
(For petrol engine model)
With your foot taken off the accelerator
pedal, crank the engine by turning the ignition key to “START”. Release the key when
the engine starts.
NOTICE
• Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or
the starter system can be damaged.
• Do not crank the engine for more
than 12 seconds at a time. If the
engine does not start on the first
try, wait about 15 seconds before
trying again.
If the engine does not start after 12 seconds of cranking, wait about 15 seconds,
and then press down the accelerator pedal
to 1/3 full of capacity and try cranking the
engine again. Release the key and accelerator pedal when the engine starts.
If the engine still does not start, try holding
the accelerator pedal all the way to the
floor while cranking. This should clear the
engine if it is flooded.
(For diesel engine model)
Cold engine
Turn the ignition switch to “ON” position
and wait until the glow plug indicator goes
out if it comes on. Crank the engine by
turning the ignition key to “START”.
Release the key when the engine starts.
NOTICE
• Stop turning the starter immediately after the engine has started or
the starter system can be damaged.
• Do not crank the engine for more
than 30 seconds at a time. If the
engine does not start on the first
try, wait about 15 seconds before
trying again.
Warm engine
Crank the engine by turning the ignition
key to “START”. Release the key when the
engine starts.
Caution when stopping the engine with
turbocharger
When stopping the engine after climbing or
high speed driving, let the engine idle for
about one minute or more (if it is not prohibited) to cool down the turbocharger and
engine oil. This is to prevent the engine oil
from
over-deteriorating.
Deteriorated
engine oil will damage the bearings of the
turbocharger.
Restarting diesel engine after fuelempty stop
If the engine stops and the low fuel warning light and the malfunction indicator light
come on, use the following procedure:
1) Fill the fuel tank.
2) Hold the ignition key in “ON” position for
5-10 seconds to feed fuel.
3) Perform above engine starting procedure to start the engine.
If the malfunction indicator light still comes
on after the engine started, there may be
some problem with the engine. Ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the engine inspected.
3-12
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Starting the engine (vehicle
with keyless push start
system)
EXAMPLE
Before starting the engine
MT
(1)
82K254
3) The “PUSH START SWITCH” message
will appear on the information display in
the instrument cluster. Push the engine
switch (1). When the engine is started,
the starter motor will automatically stop.
AGS
WARNING
EXAMPLE
66RH042
1) Make sure that the parking brake is set
fully.
2) Manual transaxle – Shift to “N” (Neutral)
and fully depress the clutch pedal. Hold
the clutch and brake pedals fully
depressed.
Auto Gear Shift – Shift into “N” (Neutral)
and depress the brake pedal. Hold the
brake pedal while starting the engine.
Make sure that the parking brake is
set fully and the transaxle is in Neutral before attempting to start the
engine.
NOTICE
NOTE:
• You do not need to keep the engine
switch pressed to start the engine.
• The engine of a manual transaxle vehicle will not start unless the clutch pedal
is depressed.
• For Auto Gear Shift vehicles, if the
engine cannot be started, make sure the
gearshift lever is in “N” before restarting
the engine.
• During the engine starting procedure,
messages on the information display will
help you. Refer to “Information display”
in the “BEFORE DRIVING” section for
details.
• You should turn off such loads as the
headlights and air conditioning system to
facilitate starting of the engine.
• Even if you fail to start the engine, the
starter motor will stop turning automatically after a short time. After the starter
motor has stopped or if there is some
problem with the system, the starter
motor will rotate only while the engine
switch is being pressed.
• Do not depress the accelerator
during the engine starting procedure.
• If the engine does not respond
when you try to start it with the
engine switch or if the engine
switch repeats cycling through
LOCK (OFF) – ACC – ON mode, the
vehicle battery may be discharged.
Check the voltage of the vehicle
battery before trying again.
3-13
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Stopping the engine
• Depress the engine switch to stop the
engine after the vehicle stopped completely.
• In case of emergency, you can stop the
engine by quickly pushing the engine
switch more than 3 times, or pushing
and holding the engine switch for more
than 2 seconds while the vehicle is in
motion.
NOTE:
Except in cases of emergency, do not stop
the engine while the vehicle is in motion.
The steering and braking operation will
require more effort when the engine is
stopped.
Refer to “Braking” in this section.
• If the engine remains stopped for while
after it was stopped unexpectedly or was
raced before stopping, a clicking sound
may be heard from around the engine
when it is restarted. This is not a malfunction. Always let the engine idle
before stopping it.
Starting a cold and warm engine
(For petrol engine model)
With your foot taken off the accelerator
pedal, crank the engine by pressing the
engine switch to change the ignition mode
to START.
NOTICE
Do not crank the engine for more
than 12 seconds at a time.
If the engine does not start on the
first try, wait about 15 seconds before
trying again.
After pressing the engine switch to change
the ignition mode to START, the starter
cranks the engine for about 12 seconds
before it can start the engine. If the engine
fails to start at the first attempt, wait about
15 seconds, and then try again while keeping the engine switch pressed while pressing down the accelerator pedal 1/3 of full
capacity. Release the accelerator pedal
when the engine starts.
If the engine still does not start, try holding
the accelerator pedal all the way to the
floor while cranking. This should clear the
engine if it is flooded.
If you are unable to start the engine using
this procedure, consult your authortised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
(For diesel engine model)
Cold engine
Depress the clutch and brake pedals fully
and press the engine switch to crank the
engine. If the glow plug indicator light
comes on, the engine will start automatically after the glow plug indicator light goes
off up to 10 seconds afterward.
NOTICE
Do not crank the engine for more
than 30 seconds at a time.
If the engine does not start on the
first try, wait about 15 seconds before
trying again.
Warm engine
Crank the engine by pressing the engine
switch to change the ignition mode to
“START”.
Caution when stopping the engine with
turbocharger
When stopping the engine after climbing or
high speed driving, let the engine idle for
about one minute or more (if it is not prohibited) to cool down the turbocharger and
engine oil. This is to prevent the engine oil
from
over-deteriorating.
Deteriorated
engine oil will damage the bearings of the
turbocharger.
3-14
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Restarting diesel engine after fuelempty stop
If the engine stops and the low fuel warning light and the malfunction indicator light
come on, use the following procedure:
1) Fill the fuel tank.
2) Press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to “ON” for 5-10 seconds
to feed fuel.
3) Perform the above engine starting procedure to start the engine.
If the malfunction indicator light still comes
on after the engine started, there may be
some problem with the engine. Ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop to
have the engine inspected.
If the master warning indicator light
blinks and the engine cannot be started
Your keyless push start system remote
controller may not be sensed as being
within the interior workable area. Try again
after checking that you have the remote
controller with you. If the engine still cannot be started, the battery of the remote
controller may be discharged. To start the
engine, use the following method:
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
68PH00304
1) Make sure that the parking brake is set
fully.
2) Manual transaxle – Shift to “N” (Neutral)
and fully depress the clutch pedal. Hold
the clutch and brake pedals fully
depressed.
Auto Gear Shift – Shift to “N” (Neutral)
and fully depress the brake pedal. Hold
the brake pedal fully depressed.
3) “PUSH START SWITCH.” message will
appear on the information display in the
instrument cluster. Press the engine
switch (1).
4) The master warning indicator light in
the instrument cluster blinks within
about 10 seconds. Touch the engine
switch with LOCK button end of remote
controller (2) for about 2 seconds.
NOTE:
• If you still cannot start the engine after
several attempts using the above
method, there may be a problem elsewhere, such as a low battery. Contact
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
for inspection.
• The immobilizer/keyless push start system warning light will come on for about
5 seconds while the master warning indicator light is blinking. In addition, the
information display will show a certain
message during this time. Refer to
“Information display” in the “BEFORE
DRIVING” section for details.
• You may customize the system to cause
the interior buzzer to sound once for
warning that remote controller is out of
sensing range. Please contact an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for the
customization.
• If the battery of the remote controller is
about to become completely discharged,
the corresponding message will appear
on the information display when you
press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON. For details on
replacing the battery, refer to “Keyless
push start system remote controller /
keyless entry system transmitter” in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section.
3-15
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Returning ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF)
NOTE:
Certain problems like a fault in engine system may prevent the engine switch from
going back to the “LOCK” (OFF) mode. If
this happens, have the vehicle inspected
by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
after doing the following:
• Lock the doors using the key to prevent
theft (The request switches and the keyless push start system remote controller
cannot be used to lock them).
• Disconnect the negative cable from the
battery to prevent discharge.
LOCK (OFF) mode reminder buzzer
If the driver’s door is opened without
returning the ignition mode to LOCK (OFF)
by pressing the engine switch, a buzzer
sounds to warn you of this state.
• If you open the driver’s door after pressing the engine switch to change the ignition mode to ACC, the interior buzzer
beeps intermittently.
• The buzzer will stop sounding if you then
push the engine switch twice, thus bringing it back the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF).
NOTE:
Whenever you leave the vehicle, make
sure that you have returned the ignition
mode to LOCK (OFF) using the engine
switch and then lock the doors. Without
returning the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF), you cannot use a request switch or
keyless push start system remote controller to lock the doors.
Steering lock warning buzzer
If the steering lock fails to engage due to a
fault in the system when the ignition mode
is turned to LOCK (OFF) by pressing the
engine switch and any door (including the
tailgate) is opened or closed, the interior
buzzer will warn you of this condition with
repeated short beeps. If this happens,
have the vehicle inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Using the transaxle
Manual transaxle
EXAMPLE
75RM254
Starting off
To start off, depress the clutch pedal all the
way to the floor and shift into 1st gear.
After releasing the parking brake, gradually
release the clutch. When you hear a
change in the engine’s sound, slowly press
the accelerator while continuing to gradually release the clutch.
Shifting
All forward gears are synchronized and provide quiet and easy shifting. Always depress
the clutch pedal all the way to the floor before
shifting gears. Keep the engine speed from
rising into the red zone of the tachometer.
3-16
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Downshifting maximum allowable speeds
For petrol engine
Downshifting
km/h
2nd to 1st
20
3rd to 2nd
80
4th to 3rd
120
5th to 4th
155
For diesel engine
Downshifting
km/h
2nd to 1st
20
3rd to 2nd
55
4th to 3rd
90
5th to 4th
135
*NOTE:
You may not accelerate to the maximum
allowable speed because of the driving situation and/or the vehicle condition.
NOTICE
Do not downshift to a lower gear at
the speed faster than the maximum
allowable speeds for the next lower
speed, or severe engine damage can
result.
WARNING
• Reduce your speed and downshift
to a lower gear before going down
a long or steep hill. A lower gear
will allow the engine to provide
braking. Avoid riding the brakes or
they may overheat, resulting in
brake failure.
• When driving on slippery roads,
slow down before downshifting.
Excessive and/or sudden changes
in engine speed may cause loss of
traction, which could cause you to
lose control.
NOTICE
Make sure that the vehicle is completely stationary before you shift
into reverse.
Auto Gear Shift
Auto Gear Shift is a 5-speed forward/
reverse transaxle.
Auto Gear Shift has the basic features of
conventional manual transaxle, but clutch
operation and transaxle gear shifting are
controlled electronically.
NOTICE
Do not depress both the brake pedal
and accelerator pedal simultaneously. This can cause damage or
overheating to the clutch.
NOTE:
When you open the driver’s door, the Auto
Gear Shift systems run automatically and
you may hear an operating noise. This
sound does not indicate malfunction.
NOTICE
• To help avoid clutch damage, do
not use the clutch pedal as a footrest while driving or use the clutch
to keep the vehicle stationary on a
slope. Depress the clutch fully
when shifting.
• When shifting or starting off, do not
race the engine. Racing the engine
can shorten engine life and cause
negative effect to smooth shifting.
3-17
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
The features are as follows:
Starting the engine
When starting the engine, always place the
gearshift lever in the “N” position and
depress the brake pedal firmly. The engine
cannot be started unless the gearshift
lever is in the “N” position and the brake
pedal is depressed.
Depress brake pedal indicator
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
76MH0A047
66RH043
EXAMPLE
This light will come on if you do not
depress the brake pedal in the following
situations.
• When starting the engine.
• When the engine is on and the gearshift
lever is shifted from “N” position to “D”,
“M” or “R” position.
• When the ignition switch is in the “ON”
position or the ignition mode is ON, and
the engine is off, the gearshift lever is
shifted into any position.
This light will also come on if one of the
gears cannot be engaged and the system
is unable to re-try shifting when you shift
the gearshift lever from “N” position to “D”,
“M” or “R” position.
If you parked vehicle with gear engaged on
last time (if you can see “1” or “R”), shift
into “N” (Neutral) and depress the brake
pedal. Hold the brake pedal while starting
the engine. You can hear buzzer in short
time.
Clutch operation
You can select either the Drive (D) mode or
the Manual (M) mode. Since this vehicle
controls clutch operation electronically in
either mode, you do not need to operate
the clutch.
66RH044
3-18
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Creeping function
This vehicle has a creeping function that
helps the vehicle to start smoothly by
engaging the clutch. When the gearshift
lever is in any of the positions “D”, “M” or
“R”, and you release your foot from the
brake pedal, the vehicle starts slowly without depressing the accelerator pedal. The
creeping function is disabled if you
depress the brake pedal or pull up the
parking brake lever. Creep is not possible
in manual mode with 2nd gear engaged.
NOTE:
If the driver’s door is opened and/or the
parking brake lever is engaged with the
gear in the “M”, “D” or “R” position, the
creeping function will not operate.
Parking and Stopping the vehicle
Auto Gear Shift does not have a parking
position. Park the vehicle with a gear
engaged. Make sure that the gearshift
lever is “D”, “M”, or “R”.
Also, check the instrument cluster to make
sure that the transaxle is engaged in “1” or
“R” position.
NOTICE
A buzzer will sound continuously if
the vehicle is operated with the gearshift lever in-between of each shift
positions. The vehicle will become
inoperative if you continue to operate
the vehicle with the gearshift lever inbetween shift positions.
Drive (D) mode
When the Drive (D) mode is activated, the
most appropriate gear position is automatically selected upon operation of the accelerator pedal and variation of vehicle
speed.
EXAMPLE
66RM03002
Normal driving:
1) Start the engine as instructed in “Starting the engine” in this section.
2) With your foot on the brake pedal, shift
the gearshift lever to the “D” position.
When the gearshift lever is shifted to
the “D” position, the gear will be shifted
to 1st.
NOTE:
• If 1st gear cannot be engaged even
though the gearshift lever has been
shifted from the “N” to the “D” position,
the system will re-try shifting automatically. This will take some time, noise
may be heard from the gears, and shifting gear shock may occur. However,
they do not indicate a malfunction.
• The “N” indicator will flush, the depress
brake pedal indicator will come on and a
warning buzzer (long pulse sound) will
sound if any of the following cases
occur;
– If you shift the gearshift lever from the
“N” to the “D” position without depressing the brake pedal.
– If the system is unable to re-try shifting
You should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position,
then shift to “D” again.
3) Release the parking brake and brake
pedal.
4) Depress the accelerator pedal slowly.
WARNING
• While driving the vehicle, do not
shift the gearshift lever to the “N”
position. The engine brake may not
work and you may get involved in
an unexpected accident. If you
return the gearshift lever from “N”
to “D” because of unintended shifting, the gear position will be shifted
according to the current vehicle
speed.
• Always keep your foot on the brake
pedal while stopped with the
engine running. This operation prevents the vehicle from moving due
to unintended activation of the
creeping function.
3-19
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTICE
If the gearshift lever cannot shift into
any position, or the gear is changed
to “N” position automatically when
the vehicle speed becomes less than
10 km/h, there may be a systematic
malfunction. In this case, ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
to inspect the Auto Gear Shift system
as soon as possible.
NOTICE
Do not operate the system as
described below. The life cycle of the
clutch may be reduced.
• Using the accelerator pedal to hold
the vehicle on an uphill slope with
the gearshift lever in the “D” or “M”
position. If you perform this operation for a certain period of time, a
warning buzzer will sound.
• Shifting the gearshift lever to the
“D”, “M” or “R” position while racing the engine.
• Driving at low speed using a high
gear.
• Holding the vehicle on an uphill
slope using the creeping function.
If you perform this operation for a
certain period of time, a warning
buzzer will sound.
Starting off on an uphill/downhill:
Uphill
1) Apply the parking brake firmly so that
the vehicle does not roll backwards.
2) Shift the gearshift lever to the “D” position while depressing the brake pedal.
Make sure that the gear position indicator in the instrumental cluster displays
1st gear.
3) Release the brake pedal and depress
the accelerator pedal gradually, and
when the vehicle starts to move,
release the parking brake and depress
the accelerator pedal to start off.
NOTICE
On an uphill slope, never hold the
vehicle at a stop using only the accelerator pedal or the creeping function.
If you perform this operation for a
certain period of time, a warning
buzzer will sound, and in some cases
the engine will stall. This can also
cause excessive damage to the
clutch.
Downhill
1) Depress the brake pedal and shift the
gearshift lever to the “D” position. Make
sure that the gear is in 1st by checking
the gear position indicator.
2) Release the brake pedal and depress
the accelerator pedal slowly. Even if the
accelerator pedal is not depressed, the
clutch will be engaged when the vehicle
speed increases.
Using engine braking:
When driving on a downhill slope, downshifting is recommended. So you can use
engine braking.
By placing the gearshift lever in the “M”
position, the Manual (M) mode is selected,
and you can shift to a lower gear manually.
For details of downshift operation, refer to
“Upshift and downshift” in the “Manual (M)
mode”.
Manual (M) mode
The gears are not shifted automatically. To
shift the transaxle, the driver must operate
the gearshift lever to the “+” or “–” direction. As for conventional manual transaxle
vehicles, releasing the accelerator pedal a
little may help the transaxle to shift
smoothly.
3-20
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Upshift and downshift:
Downshifting
The gear position is displayed on the gear
position indicator. The gear position indicator shows the transaxle gear position.
Before starting off, always make sure the
gear position indicator to make sure that
the transaxle is engaged in 1st or reverse,
then depress the accelerator pedal. It’s
possible to start-off vehicle in 2nd gear
using manual mode, from stop condition.
Upshifting
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RH046
66RH045
Pull the gearshift lever to the “+” direction
and release it. Every time the lever is operated, the transaxle is upshifting 1 step in
the order of 1st 2nd 3rd 4th 5th
gear.
Push the gearshift lever to the “–” direction
and release it. Every time the lever is operated, the transaxle is downshifted in the
order 5th 4th 3rd 2nd 1st gear.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RM03004
NOTE:
• Always use 1st gear while starting off an
uphill slope, otherwise you can damage
the clutch.
• To downshift smoothly, the engine runs
fast in some cases. This is done intentionally by the system and is not malfunction.
• When driving down a hill, downshift and
use the engine braking appropriately. If
necessary, continuous downshifting is
possible. However, if downshifting more
than 3 steps, gear shifting will take more
time.
• When the gear is shifting, a noise can be
heard in some case. This is not malfunction.
66RM03003
3-21
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
• Be careful when accelerating,
upshifting, downshifting or braking
on a slippery surface. Sudden
acceleration or engine braking
could cause the vehicle to spin or
skid. While starting off on a slippery or snowy roads, please use
2nd gear (if required).
• To drive down a long or steep hill,
reduce your speed and downshift.
Remember, if you ride the brakes
excessively, they may overheat and
fail.
• While driving the vehicle, do not
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position. The engine brake may not
work and you may get involved in
an unexpected accident. If you
return the gearshift lever from “N”
to “M” because of unintended shifting, the gear position will be shifted
according to the current vehicle
speed.
• Do not apply the parking brake
while driving. Otherwise, it could
cause a skid and you may get
involved in an unexpected accident.
NOTICE
• If the gearshift lever cannot shift
into any position, or the gear is
changed to “N” position automatically when the vehicle speed
becomes less than 10 km/h, there
may be a systematic malfunction.
In this case, ask your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop to inspect
the Auto Gear Shift system as soon
as possible.
• In manual (M) mode, the system
does not upshift even if the engine
speed reaches the rev-limit.
• The system will not allow shifting
up or down to a gear that would
cause engine over-revving or
under-revving.
• If frequently driving at low speed
using a high gear position, the life
cycle of the clutch may be reduced.
• Frequent downshifting (more than
3 positions consecutively) causes
the reduction of transaxle life.
Starting off:
1) Start the engine as instructed in “Starting the engine” in this section.
2) With your foot on the brake pedal, shift
the gearshift lever to the “M” position.
When the gearshift lever is shifted to
the “M” position, the gear will be shifted
to 1st. Before starting off, always make
sure that the intended gear is engaged
by checking the gear position indicator,
then depress the accelerator pedal.
NOTE:
• If 1st gear cannot be engaged even
though the gearshift lever has been
shifted from the “N” to the “M” position,
the system will re-try shifting automatically. This will take some time, noise
may be heard from the gears, and shifting gear shock may occur. However,
they do not indicate malfunction.
• The “N” indicator will flash, the depress
brake pedal indicator will come on and a
warning buzzer (long pulse sound) will
sound if any of the following cases
occur;
– If you shift the gearshift lever from the
“N” to the “M” position without
depressing the brake pedal.
– If the system is unable to re-try shifting
You should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position,
then shift to “M” position again a few
seconds later.
3-22
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
3) Release the parking brake and brake
pedal. Depress the accelerator pedal
slowly for smooth starting.
WARNING
Always keep your foot on the brake
pedal while stopped with the engine
running. These operations prevent
the vehicle from starting due to unintended activation of the creeping
function.
NOTICE
Do not operate the system as
described below. The life cycle of the
clutch may be reduced.
• Using the accelerator pedal to hold
the vehicle on an uphill slope operation with the gearshift lever in the
“M” or “D” position. If you perform
this operation for a certain period
of time, a warning buzzer will
sound.
• Shifting the gearshift lever to the
“M”, “D” or “R” position while racing the engine.
• Driving at low speed using a high
gear.
• Stopping on a slope using the
creeping function. If you perform
this operation for a certain period
of time, a warning buzzer will
sound.
Starting off on an uphill/downhill slope:
Uphill
1) Apply the parking brake firmly so that
the vehicle does not roll backwards.
2) Shift the gearshift lever to the “M” position while depressing the brake pedal.
Make sure that the gear position indicator in the instrumental cluster displays
1st gear.
3) Release the brake pedal and depress
the accelerator pedal gradually, and
when the vehicle starts to move,
release the parking brake and depress
the accelerator pedal to start off.
NOTICE
On an uphill slope, never hold the
vehicle at a stop using only the accelerator pedal or creeping function. If
you perform this operation for a certain period of time, a warning buzzer
will sound, and in some cases the
engine will stall. This can also cause
excessive damage to the clutch.
Downhill
1) Depress the brake pedal and shift the
gearshift lever to the “M” position. Make
sure the gear position indicator to make
sure that the gear is in 1st.
2) Release the brake pedal and depress
the accelerator pedal slowly. Even
though the accelerator pedal is not
depressed, the clutch will be engaged
when the vehicle speed increases.
Backing up
After the vehicle has stopped completely,
depress the brake pedal and shift the gearshift lever to the “R” position. Depress the
accelerator pedal slowly as when starting
off in 1st gear. Before backing up, make
sure that reverse gear is selected by
checking the gear position indicator.
NOTE:
• If reverse gear cannot be engaged even
though the gearshift lever has been
shifted from the “N” to the “R” position,
the system will re-try shifting automatically. This will take some time, noise
may be heard from the gears, and shifting gear shock may occur. However,
they do not indicate malfunction.
• The “N” indicator will flash, the depress
brake pedal indicator will come on and a
warning buzzer (long pulse sound) will
sound if any of the following cases
occur;
3-23
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
– If you shift the gearshift lever from the
“N” to the “R” position without depressing the brake pedal.
– If the system is unable to re-try shifting.
You should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position,
then shift to “R” position again a few seconds later.
• The system will not allow shifting to the
“R” position if the vehicle speed is over
about 3 km/h. If the gearshift lever is
operated under this condition, the “N”
indicator in the instrument cluster will
blink. However, when the vehicle speed
drops below about 3 km/h, the gear will
be shifted to reverse. Make sure that the
vehicle has stopped completely before
shifting to the “R” position.
NOTICE
On a downhill slope, never hold the
vehicle at a stop using only the accelerator pedal or the creeping function.
If you perform this operation for a
certain period of time, a warning
buzzer will sound, and in some cases
the engine will stall. This can also
cause excessive damage to the
clutch.
Stopping
The vehicle can be stopped by depressing
the brake pedal regardless of the gear
position. This is because the clutch is automatically disengaged to prevent the engine
from stopping.
• If the gearshift lever is in the “D” position,
the gear will be downshifted to 1st when
the vehicle stops.
• If the gearshift lever is in the “M” position, the gear will be downshifted to 1st
when the vehicle stops.
WARNING
• When stopping, for example, at a
traffic light, be sure to depress the
brake pedal firmly. For your safety,
apply the parking brake, too, when
stopping on a hill.
• When racing the engine, make sure
that the gear is in the “N” position
by checking the gear position indicator. If the accelerator is operated
with the gear in any other position,
the vehicle may move resulting in
an unexpected accident.
• Do not leave your vehicle unattended while the engine is running.
• When leaving the vehicle, stop the
engine and park the vehicle with a
gear engaged. Remember, even
though the transaxle is in gear, you
must set the parking brake firmly. If
you need to leave the vehicle with
the engine running, apply the parking brakes firmly, and shift the
gearshift lever to the “N” position
and confirm the neutral position by
checking the gear position indicator. However basically don’t leave
the vehicle with the engine running.
Otherwise, the vehicle may move
unexpectedly and may cause an
accident.
3-24
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTICE
• On a slope, never hold the vehicle
at a stop using only the accelerator
pedal or the creeping function. If
you perform this operation for a
certain period of time, a warning
buzzer will sound, and in some
cases the engine will stall. This can
also cause excessive damage to
the clutch.
• If the gearshift lever is operated
more than necessary, the system
may not allow operation of the
gearshift lever for a certain period
of time, and the gear may not be
shifted appropriately. Therefore, do
not operate the gearshift lever if not
necessary.
Parking
Unlike an automatic transaxle, Auto Gear
Shift does not have a parking position. The
vehicle can be parked with the gearshift
lever at “D” or “R” position. Remember,
even though the transaxle is in gear, you
must set the parking brake firmly.
1) Apply the parking brake and the brake
pedal firmly.
2) While depressing the brake pedal, shift
the gearshift lever to the “R” position on
a downhill slope, and to the 1st position
in the drive (D) mode or the “M (1)”
position in the manual (M) mode on an
uphill slope and confirm the gear posi-
tion by checking the gear position indicator.
3) Stop the engine completely.
4) In the case of uphill/downhill slope,
release the parking brake and brake
pedal slowly in order to check the gear
is engaged.
5) After check the vehicle stopped by the
gear engaged, Apply the parking brake
and the brake pedal firmly again.
6) Get out of the vehicle and put chocks
under the wheels.
When you return to your vehicle, you must
remember to remove the wheel chocks.
NOTE:
• After the engine is stopped or ignition
switch is OFF, the gear in the transaxle
does not change even if you shift the
gearshift lever in any position. Always
shift the gearshift lever before turn ignition switch OFF.
• Check the transaxle gear position by
looking at the gear position indicator,
then turn the ignition switch off to stop
the engine.
WARNING
• If the gear is not engaged properly
and completely before the ignition
switch is turned to “LOCK” position or the engine switch is pressed
to change the ignition mode to
LOCK (OFF), the vehicle may not
be parked with the gear engaged.
Always confirm the gear position
by checking the gear position indicator when parking.
• On a downhill slope, the gear
should be put in reverse, and in 1st
gear on an uphill slope. In the case
of uphill/downhill slope, after check
the vehicle stopped by the gear
engaged, put chocks under the
wheels. Otherwise, the vehicle may
move, and cause an unexpected
accident. If the gear is left in the
“N” position, the vehicle cannot be
parked with a gear engaged.
3-25
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Parking cancel
Depress the brake pedal, turn the ignition
switch to “ON” position or press the engine
switch to change the ignition mode to ON,
and shift the gearshift lever to the “N” position. The gear will be disengaged.
Warning functions
A warning buzzer will sound or the indicator will blink under the following conditions.
Warning buzzer
• The clutch is heated due to excessive
load.
• The creeping function is being activated
for a long period of time.
NOTICE
In the above cases, pull over to the
side of the road and stop the engine,
and then ask your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop to inspect your
vehicle. Otherwise, the clutch disc
may be damaged.
• The ignition switch is turned to the
“LOCK” position or the engine switch is
pressed to change the ignition mode to
LOCK (OFF) with the gear in 2nd, 3rd,
4th or 5th. In this case, turn the ignition
switch to “ON” position or press the
engine switch to change the ignition
mode to ON, and shift the gearshift lever
in the “N” position, shift it to the “D” or
“M” or “R” position, then turn the ignition
switch to “LOCK” position or press the
engine switch to change the ignition
mode to LOCK (OFF).
• During a stop, the driver’s door is
opened with the gearshift lever in the
“R”, “D” or “M” position while the engine
is running.
“N” indicator blinking
When the gear indicator lamp blinks “N”,
you should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position.
“1st” indicator blinking
When the gear indicator lamp blinks “1st”,
you should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position, then
shift to “D” or “M” position again a few seconds later.
“R” indicator blinking
When the gear indicator lamp blinks “R”,
you should depress the brake pedal and
shift the gearshift lever to “N” position, then
shift to “R” position again a few seconds
later.
3-26
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Gearshift indicator
(if equipped)
WARNING
The gearshift indicator is designed to indicate optimal gear position for your
driving, however, a driver will not be relieved from the duty of care of driving
operation or gear change with this indicator.
To drive safe, do not gaze the gearshift indicator, pay attention to your driving
situation and shift up or down if necessary.
EXAMPLE
75RM327
When the gearshift lever is in a position
other than “N” (Neutral), the gearshift indicator is indicated on the information display when the ignition switch is in “ON”
position or the ignition mode is ON.
The electronic control system monitors
driving condition (such as vehicle speed
and/or engine revolution), and it shows
which gear position is optimal for your driving with the indication on the display.
If UP/DOWN arrow is indicated on the display while driving, we recommend you to
shift up or down the gear until the arrow
disappears. It is the optimal gear position
for a driving condition that reduces the
over revolution and stress to the engine,
and improves fuel consumption.
NOTE:
• The gearshift indicator is not indicated when the gear position is in “N” (Neutral).
• If you depress the clutch pedal while UP/DOWN arrow is indicated, the indication will
disappear.
• The indication of gearshift indicator timing may differ depending on the vehicle condition
and/or driving situation even in the same vehicle speed and engine revolution.
Example of the gearshift indicator
Indication
Description
Lower gear position is selected for the vehicle speed and/
or engine revolution. Changing to a higher gear position is
recommended.
Higher gear position is selected for the vehicle speed and/
or engine revolution. Changing to a lower gear position is
recommended.
For details on how to use the transaxle,
refer to “Using transaxle” in this section.
3-27
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Parking sensors (if equipped)
• The parking sensor system uses ultrasonic sensors to detect obstacles near
the rear bumper. If obstacles are sensed
while you are parking or moving the
vehicle slowly, the system warns you by
sounding a buzzer.
• The system emits an ultrasonic wave
and the relevant sensor detects the
return of the wave reflected by an obstacle. The system measures the time
taken by the ultrasonic wave to reach the
obstacle and return from it, from which it
determines the obstacle’s position.
• The parking sensor function can be used
when you press the engine switch to
change the ignition mode to “ON”, the
gearshift lever is in the reverse position
and the parking sensor switch is in “ON”
position. This function is helpful in the
following cases: pulling over to the curb;
parallel parking the vehicle; steering the
vehicle into a garage; driving along an
alley; and moving slowly in a place with
obstacles.
WARNING
• The parking sensor warns you of
obstacles with buzzers. However,
you still have to drive with particular care.
• The sensors can detect obstacles
only within a limited area and only
when the vehicle is moving within a
limited speed range. So, in tricky
areas, you must move the vehicle
slowly while checking around it
using your direct vision or rearview
mirrors. There is increased risk of
an accident if you control the vehicle relying only on the parking sensor.
NOTICE
• Parking sensor are only for driver’s
assistance.
Sensor locations
On rear bumper
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
(1) (2)
66RH047
(1) Rear center sensors (2 places)
(2) Rear corner sensors (2 places)
NOTICE
• Avoid hitting the sensor areas or
directing the nozzle of a high-pressure car washer onto the sensor
areas. Otherwise, the sensors may
be damaged.
• If the bumper hits a hard object, the
sensors on it may not work properly. If this occurs, have the sensors inspected by an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
3-28
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Working sensors
The sensors work depending on the gearshift lever position and parking brake lever position as follows:
Rear sensors
Manual transaxle
Auto Gear Shift
EXAMPLE
N, 1st – 5th
R
N, D, M
Parking
brake lever
Center On
Off
On
Off
No relation
Corner On
Off
On
Off
No relation
Gearshift lever
position
R
Approximate areas where obstacles can
be detected
66RH048
• An obstacle within about 20 cm (8 in)
from a sensor or just below a sensor is
not detectable.
• The sensors can detect an obstacle up
to about 1.5 m (5 ft) from the rear of
vehicle.
3-29
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
• Under the following conditions, the
parking sensor system may not
work normally because the sensors
cannot detect obstacles correctly.
– Sensors are covered with mud,
ice or other materials (Such
materials must be removed for
normal operation).
– Sensors are wet from water
splashes or heavy rain.
– Sensors are covered by a hand,
sticker, accessory, etc.
– There is an accessory or other
object attached within the sensor’s sensing area.
– Items such as tow hooks, commercially available corner poles,
radio antenna, etc. are installed
on the bumper.
– The height of the bumper is
changed due to alteration to the
suspension or other causes.
– The sensor areas are extremely
hot from direct sunlight or cold
due to freezing weather.
– The vehicle is on a rough surface, slope, gravel road or grass
field.
– The vehicle is at a steep angle.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
– Sensors have intercepted ultrasonic noise from another vehicle’s horn, engine, air braking
system (large vehicles), or parking sensor.
– Obstacles are too close to the
sensors.
– Sensors are at an angle to a
highly reflective object such as
glass (Ultrasonic waves are not
reflected back from the obstacle).
• Sensors may not be able to correctly detect the following types of
obstacles:
– Objects made of a thin material
such as wire netting and ropes.
– Square-shaped curbstones or
other objects with sharp edges.
– Tall objects with a large upper
part such as a road sign.
– Low-profile objects such as curbstones.
– Sound-absorbing objects such
as cotton and snow.
NOTE:
• Thin poles or obstacles lower than the
sensors may become undetectable as
the vehicle moves closer to them even if
they have been detected from longer
distances.
• The system may calculate the distance
to a road sign or similar obstacle to be
shorter than the actual distance.
3-30
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
How to use parking sensor
State
Obstacle indication by parking sensor
EXAMPLE
ON
• When the indicator
light is on and all necessary conditions are
met, system becomes
ready for operation.
Upon detecting an obstacle, the parking
sensor causes an interior buzzer to sound.
• A buzzer located behind the rear seat
sounds when a sensor at the rear
detects an obstacle.
• Warnings when obstacles are detected
by corner sensors.
EXAMPLE
OFF
• The system does not
operate. Push the
switch to turn off the
indicator if you do not
wish to use the parking sensor.
Switch
position
Parking sensor switch
(2)
(1)
EXAMPLE
66RH120
(1) Parking sensor switch
(2) Indicator
• When the ignition mode is ON and the
indicator light in the parking sensor
switch is on, indicating that the parking
sensor is ready for operation under the
following conditions:
– The gearshift lever is in a position.
• To deactivate the parking sensor, push
the parking sensor switch and check that
the indicator light goes off.
NOTE:
• If you push the parking sensor switch
from OFF to ON position when the ignition mode has been changed to ON by
pressing the engine switch, the interior
buzzer sounds.
• When the gearshift lever is shifted to the
“R” position with the system ON, a
buzzer will sound once.
Distance
(approx.)
Buzzer
45 – 60 cm
(18 – 24 in)
Short beeps at short
intervals
35 – 45 cm
(14 – 18 in)
Short beeps at very
short intervals
Less than
35 cm (14 in)
Continuous beep
3-31
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
• Warnings when obstacles are detected
by center sensors.
Distance
(approx.)
Buzzer
60 – 150 cm
(24 – 59 in)
Short beeps at long
intervals
45 – 60 cm
(18 – 24 in)
Short beeps at short
intervals
35 – 45 cm
(14 – 18 in)
Less than
35 cm (14 in)
Short beeps at very
short intervals
Continuous beep
Warning and indicator messages
If there is a problem or warning regarding
the parking sensor system, a buzzer and
the status of the indicator on the parking
sensor inform it. Follow its instruction.
• The buzzer sounds intermittently. The
indicated sensor is contaminated. Wipe
it clean with a soft cloth. If the buzzer
does not stop after wiping, there may be
problem with the parking sensor system.
Have your vehicle inspected by an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
• The indicator does not come on when
the parking sensor switch is pressed.
The indicator goes off while operating.
There may be a problem with the parking
sensor system, Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
Rearview camera
(if equipped)
When the gearshift lever is shifted to “R”
position while the ignition mode is ON, the
rearview camera system automatically
shows the view behind the vehicle on the
display.
WARNING
NOTICE
If you use the rearview camera for a
long time when the ignition mode is
ON, but the engine is not running, the
battery may discharge.
Do not leave the ignition mode ON for
a long time when the engine is not
running.
The distance viewed in the rearview
camera may differ from the actual
distance according to the condition
of road or the load the vehicle is carrying. Since the camera display area
is also limited, backing up by only
looking at the display may cause an
accident or a crash with an object.
The rearview camera cannot replace
the driver’s attention. The driver
alone is responsible for parking and
similar driving maneuvers.
• Use the rearview camera only to
provide driving assistance.
• Always drive carefully confirming
the safety of the rear and the surrounding conditions by looking
directly with your eyes and using
the rear view mirror.
• Make sure that the tailgate is
securely closed when backing up.
3-32
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Rearview camera location
NOTICE
If water enters the rearview camera, it
may cause a malfunction or catch
fire.
Do not use high pressure water
around the camera.
NOTICE
(1)
EXAMPLE
66RH049
(1) Rearview camera
The rearview camera is installed beside
the license plate light.
NOTICE
The rearview camera is a precision
instrument. If you strike the camera,
it may be broken and cause damage
resulting in a catch fire or a malfunction.
• Do not strike the camera.
• Do not remove snow or mud on the
camera lens with a stick.
This lens is hard coated to prevent
damage or discoloration. Damage or
discoloration of lens may obscure
the image.
• Do not use a brush to clean lens.
• Do not use alcohol, benzene or
thinner to clean the lens.
• Do not use wax on the camera lens.
NOTE:
If body wax gets on the camera lens, wipe
off the wax with a clean cloth dampened
with mild detergent diluted with water, and
then wipe the lens with a dry cloth.
How to use rearview camera
1) Press the engine switch to change the
ignition mode to ON.
2) Shift the gearshift lever in “R” position.
• The display automatically shows the
view behind the vehicle.
• When the gearshift lever is shifted
from “R” to another gearshift lever
position, the display returns to the
previous display.
NOTE:
The rearview camera display has first priority in any display mode. However, the
rearview camera display does not show
the rear view while the system is initializing.
Display range of rearview camera
The rearview camera display shows the
area behind the rear end of the tailgate.
The display cannot show objects which are
close to the bumper or under the bumper.
The rearview camera display cannot show
obstacles which are higher than the camera. Upper parts of tall objects such as
road signs cannot be viewed on the display.
3-33
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Display range of rearview camera
EXAMPLE
(1)
75RM293
EXAMPLE
(1)
54P000370
(1) Display range
NOTE:
• Images shown on the display from the
rearview camera are reversed images
(mirror images).
• The colors of objects on the rearview
camera may differ from the actual object
colors.
• The rearview camera display may be difficult to see under the following conditions, but this is not a system
malfunction.
– In dark areas, on a rainy day or at
night.
– When the temperature around the lens
is too high/low, or the camera is wet
such as on a rainy day or during periods of high humidity (dew condensation may occur on the camera lens).
– When a foreign object such as mud or
a drop of water is stuck around the
camera lens.
– When strong light directly enters the
camera (vertical lines may be seen on
the display).
– Under fluorescent light (The display
may flicker).
– When the outside temperature is low
(the image on the display may be
darkened).
Uphill incline behind the vehicle
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(3)
75RM294
(1) Object
(2) Actual distance
(3) Distance on the display
When there is an uphill incline behind the
vehicle, the object shown on the display
appears farther away than the actual distance.
Rearview camera screen indication
The distance viewed in the rearview camera may differ from the actual distance
according to the condition of the road or
the load the vehicle is carrying.
3-34
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
Downhill incline behind the vehicle
EXAMPLE
(1)
(3)
(2)
75RM295
(1) Object
(2) Actual distance
(3) Distance on the display
When there is a downhill incline behind the
vehicle, the object shown on the display
appears closer than the actual distance.
If the rear view from the rearview camera is not shown or there is a poor
image
• If the rear view from the rearview camera
is not shown.
– Check that the ignition mode is ON.
– Check that the gearshift lever is
shifted to “R” position.
• If the image from the rearview camera is
poor.
– Check that the camera lens is not dirty.
– Check that light from the sun or the
beam of the headlights from the vehicle behind is not shining directly into
the lens.
If the rearview camera system is still not
working properly after checking the above,
have the system inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop as soon as
possible.
Braking
EXAMPLE
60G165S
The distance needed to bring any vehicle
to a halt increases with the speed of the
vehicle. The braking distance needed, for
example, at 60 km/h will be approximately
4 times greater than the braking distance
needed at 30 km/h. Start to depress the
brake pedal when there is plenty of distance between your vehicle and the stopping point, and slow down gradually.
3-35
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
If water gets into the brake devices,
brake performance may become poor
and unpredictable. After driving
through water or washing the underside of the vehicle, test the brakes
while driving at a slow speed to see if
they have maintained their normal
effectiveness. If the brakes are less
effective than normal, dry them by
repeatedly applying the brakes while
driving slowly until the brakes have
regained their normal effectiveness.
Power-assisted brakes
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes. If
power assistance is lost due to a stalled
engine or other failures, the system is still
fully operational on reserve power and you
can bring the vehicle to a complete stop by
pressing the brake pedal once and holding
it down. The reserve power is partly used
up when you depress the brake pedal and
reduces each time the pedal is pressed.
Apply smooth and even pressure to the
pedal. Do not pump the pedal.
WARNING
Even without reserve power in the
brake system, you can still stop the
vehicle by pressing the brake pedal
harder than normally required. However, the stopping distance may be
longer.
Brake assist system
When you slam the brakes on, the brake
assist system determines it to be an emergency stop and provides more powerful
braking for a driver who cannot hold down
the brake pedal firmly.
NOTE:
If you quickly and forcefully depress the
brakes, you may hear clicking sound by
the brake assist system operation. This is
normal and indicates that the brake assist
system is activated properly.
Anti-lock brake system (ABS)
ABS will help you avoid skidding by electronically controlling braking pressure. It
will also help you maintain steering control
when braking on slippery surfaces or when
braking hard.
The ABS works automatically, so you do
not need any special braking technique.
Just push the brake pedal down without
pumping. The ABS will operate whenever
it senses that the wheels are locking up.
You may feel the brake pedal move a little
while the ABS is operating.
NOTE:
• The ABS will not work if vehicle speed is
under about 9 km/h.
• If the ABS system is activated, you may
hear a clunking noise and/or feel pulsating in the brake pedal. This is normal
and indicates that the brake fluid pressure is being controlled properly.
• You may hear an operation sound when
you start the engine or after the vehicle
begins to move. This means that the
above systems are in the self-check
mode. This sound does not indicate a
malfunction.
WARNING
• On some types of loose surfaces
(such as gravel, snow-covered
roads, etc.), the stopping distance
required for a vehicle with ABS
may be slightly greater than the
one required for a comparable vehicle with a conventional brake system. With a conventional brake
system, skidding tires are able to
plow the gravel or snow layer,
shortening the stopping distance.
ABS minimizes this resistance
effect. Allow for extra stopping distance when driving on loose surfaces.
(Continued)
3-36
66RH0-74E
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING
WARNING
(Continued)
• On regular paved roads, some drivers may be able to obtain slightly
shorter stopping distances with
conventional brake systems than
with ABS.
• In both of the above conditions,
ABS will still offer the advantage of
helping you maintain directional
control. However, remember that
ABS will not compensate for bad
road or weather conditions or poor
driver judgment. Use good judgment and do not drive too fast.
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
• If the ABS warning light (1) on the
instrument cluster comes on and
stays on while driving, there may
be a problem with the ABS system.
Ask your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop to inspect the ABS system immediately. If the ABS system
becomes inoperative, the brake
system will function as an ordinary
brake system that has no ABS.
• If the ABS warning light (1) and the
brake system warning light (2) on
the instrument cluster simultaneously stay on or come on while
driving, both anti-lock function and
rear brake force control function
(proportioning valve function) of
the ABS system may have failed. If
so, the rear wheels may easily skid
or the vehicle can even spin in the
worst case when braking on a slippery road or when hard braking
even on a dry paved road. Ask your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
to inspect the ABS system immediately. Drive carefully, avoiding hard
braking as much as possible.
How ABS works
A computer continuously monitors wheel
speed. The computer compares the
changes in wheel speed when braking. If
the wheels slow suddenly, indicating a
skidding situation, the computer will
change braking pressure several times
each second to prevent the wheels from
locking. When you start your vehicle or
when you accelerate after a hard stop, you
may hear a momentary motor or clicking
noise as the system resets or checks itself.
WARNING
The ABS may not work properly if
tires or wheels other than those
specified in the owner’s manual are
used. This is because the ABS works
by comparing changes in wheel
speed. When replacing tires or
wheels, use only the size and type
specified in this owner’s manual.
54MN069
(1) ABS warning light
(2) Brake system warning light
3-37
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
DRIVING TIPS
Running-in ........................................................................... 4-1
Catalytic converter .............................................................. 4-1
Improving fuel economy ..................................................... 4-2
Highway driving .................................................................. 4-3
Driving on hills .................................................................... 4-3
Driving on slippery roads ................................................... 4-4
Driving on wet roads ........................................................... 4-6
Do’s and Dont’s for safe driving......................................... 4-6
Margin for safety .................................................................. 4-9
4
60G409
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Running-in
EXAMPLE
Catalytic converter
NOTICE
68PHM4001
WARNING
• WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS AT ALL
TIMES. Even though air bags are
equipped at the front seating positions, the driver and all passengers
should be properly restrained at all
times, using the seat belts provided. Refer to “Seat belts and
child restraint systems” section for
instructions on proper use of the
seat belts.
• Never drive under the influence of
alcohol or other drugs. Alcohol and
drugs can seriously impair your
ability to drive safely, greatly
increasing the risk of injury to
yourself and others. You should
also avoid driving when you are
tired, sick, irritated or under stress.
The future performance and reliability of the engine depends on the care
and restraint exercised during its
early life. It is especially important to
observe the following precautions
during the first 960 km of vehicle
operation.
• After starting, do not race the
engine. Warm it up gradually.
• Avoid prolonged vehicle operation
at a constant speed. Moving parts
will break in better if you vary your
speed.
• Start off from a stop slowly. Avoid
full throttle starts.
• Avoid hard braking, especially
during the first 320 km of driving.
• Do not drive slowly with the transaxle in a high gear.
• Drive the vehicle at moderate
engine speeds.
• Do not tow a trailer.
EXAMPLE
80G106
The purpose of the catalytic converter is to
minimize the amount of harmful pollutants
in your vehicle’s exhaust. Use of leaded
fuel in vehicles equipped with catalytic
converters is prohibited, because lead
deactivates the pollutant-reducing components of the catalyst system.
The converter is designed to last the life of
the vehicle under normal usage and when
unleaded fuel is used. No special maintenance is required on the converter. However, it is very important to keep the engine
properly tuned. Engine misfiring, which can
result from an improperly tuned engine,
may cause overheating of the catalytic
converter. This may result in permanent
heat damage to the catalytic converter and
other vehicle components.
4-1
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
NOTICE
To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter or other vehicle damage:
• Maintain the engine in the proper
operating condition.
• In the event of an engine malfunction, particularly one involving
engine misfire or other apparent
loss of performance, have the vehicle serviced promptly.
• Do not turn off the engine or interrupt the ignition when the transaxle
is in gear and the vehicle is in
motion.
• Do not try to start the engine by
pushing or towing the vehicle, or
coasting down a hill.
• Do not idle the engine with any
spark plug wires disconnected or
removed, such as during diagnostic testing.
• Do not idle the vehicle for prolonged periods if idling seems
rough or there are other malfunctions.
• Do not allow the fuel tank to get
near the empty level.
Improving fuel economy
EXAMPLE
The following instructions will help you
improve fuel economy.
Avoid excessive idling
If you are to wait for more than a minute
while you are parked, stop the engine and
start it again later. When warming up a
cold engine, do not allow the engine to idle
or apply full throttle until the engine has
reached operating temperature. Allow the
engine to warm up by driving.
54G584S
WARNING
Be careful where you park and drive;
the catalytic converter and other
exhaust components can get very
hot. As with any vehicle, do not park
or operate this vehicle in areas where
combustible materials such as dry
grass or leaves can come in contact
with a hot exhaust system.
Avoid sudden acceleration
Sudden acceleration starting from rest or
while driving will consume fuel unnecessarily and shorten engine life. Start off
slowly.
Avoid unnecessary stops
Avoid unnecessary deceleration and stopping. Try to maintain a slow, steady speed
whenever possible. Slowing down and
then accelerating again uses more fuel.
Keep a steady cruising speed
Drive at a constant speed that road and
traffic conditions will permit.
4-2
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Highway driving
Keep the air cleaner clean
EXAMPLE
60A183S
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there
will be greater intake resistance, resulting
in decreased power output and increased
fuel consumption.
Keep weight to a minimum
The heavier the load is, the more fuel the
vehicle consumes. Unload any unnecessary luggage or cargo.
When driving at highway speeds, pay
attention to the following:
• Stopping
distance
progressively
increases with vehicle speed. Apply the
brakes far enough ahead of the stopping
point to allow for the extra stopping distance.
• On rainy days, hydroplaning can occur.
Hydroplaning is the loss of direct contact
between the road surface and the vehicle’s tires due to a water film forming
between them. Steering or braking the
vehicle during hydroplaning can be very
difficult, and loss of control can occur.
Keep speed down when the road surface is wet.
• At high speeds, the vehicle may be
affected by side winds. Therefore,
reduce speed and be prepared for unexpected buffeting, which can occur at the
exits of tunnels, when passing by a cut
of a hill, or when being overtaken by
large vehicles, etc.
Driving on hills
Manual transaxle
EXAMPLE
75RM260
Auto Gear Shift
Keep tire pressures correct
Under-inflation of the tires can waste fuel
due to increased running resistance of the
tires. Keep your tires inflated to the correct
pressure shown on the label on the driver’s
side door or the driver’s door lock pillar.
EXAMPLE
66RH046
4-3
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
• When climbing steep hills, the vehicle
may begin to slow down and show a lack
of power. If this happens, you should
shift to a lower gear so that the engine
will again be operating in its normal
power range. Shift rapidly to prevent the
vehicle from losing momentum.
• When driving down a hill, the engine
should be used for braking by shifting to
the next lower gear.
NOTICE
When descending a downhill, Never
turn the ignition key to “LOCK” position or press the engine switch to
change the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF). Emission control system damage may result.
Driving on slippery roads
EXAMPLE
While moving uphill/gradient from a
stand still condition
• Apply the parking brake firmly so that the
vehicle does not roll backwards.
• Depress the Clutch pedal and Shift the
gearshift lever to 1st Select position.
• Do not slip the clutch.
• When ready to start, press accelerator
pedal and slowly release the clutch
pedal simultaneously. When the vehicle
starts to move, gradually release the
parking brake.
WARNING
60G089S
On wet roads, you should drive at a lower
speed than you do on dry roads due to
possible slippage of tires during braking.
When driving on icy, snow-covered or
muddy roads, reduce your speed and
avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt braking,
or sharp steering movements.
Do not hold the brake pedal down too
long or too often while going down a
steep or long hill. This could cause
the brakes to overheat, resulting in
reduced braking efficiency. Failure to
take this precaution could result in
loss of vehicle control.
4-4
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Tire chains
Tire chains should only be used if they are
needed to increase traction or are required
by law. Check that the chains you use are
the correct size for your vehicle’s tires.
Also check that there is enough clearance
between the fenders and the chains as
installed on the tires.
Install the chains on the front tires tightly,
according to the chain manufacturer’s
instructions. Retighten the chains after
driving about 1.0 km if necessary. With the
chains installed, drive slowly.
NOTICE
• If you hear the chains hitting
against the vehicle body while driving, stop and tighten them.
• If your vehicle is equipped with full
wheel caps, remove the wheel caps
before installing the chains or the
wheel caps can be damaged by the
chain bands.
Stuck vehicle
If your vehicle gets stuck in snow, mud or
sand, follow the directions below:
1) Shift the transaxle back and forth
between the first gear and reverse. This
will create a rocking motion which may
give you enough momentum to free the
vehicle. Press gently on the accelerator
to keep wheel spinning to a minimum
wheel rpm. Remove your foot from the
accelerator while shifting.
Do not race the engine. Excessive
wheel spin will cause the tires to dig
deeper, making it more difficult to free
the vehicle.
2) If your vehicle remains stuck after a few
minutes of rocking, we recommend you
to consult your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop or a roadside assistance service. If a towing service is not
available in an emergency, your vehicle
may be temporarily towed by a towing
cable or chain secured to the towing
hook either on the front of the vehicle or
on the rear of the vehicle. Refer to
“Frame hooks” in the “OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT” section.
WARNING
Do not allow anyone to stand near
the vehicle when you are rocking it,
and do not spin the wheels faster
than an indicated 40 km/h on the
speedometer. Personal injury and/or
vehicle damage may result from spinning the wheels too fast.
NOTICE
Do not continue rocking the vehicle
for more than a few minutes. Prolonged rocking can cause engine
overheating or transaxle damage.
4-5
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Driving on wet roads
WARNING
EXAMPLE
82PHM04001
NOTICE
• When driving on wet roads, avoid
driving through large amount of
standing water on the road. Large
amount of water entering the
engine compartment may cause
damage to the engine and or electrical components.
• If stuck in deep water, do not start
the engine.
• Water is incompressible substance,
water inside engine is harmful to
the engine.
In addition to following the driving
tips in this section, it is important to
observe the following precautions.
• Check that your tires are in good
condition and always maintain the
specified tire pressure. Refer to
“Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE”
section
for
details.
• Do not use tires other than those
specified by MARUTI SUZUKI.
Never use different sizes or types
of tires on the front and rear
wheels. For information regarding
the specified tires, refer to the tire
information label located on the
driver’s door lock pillar.
• Never use oversized tires or special shock absorbers and springs
to raise (jack up) your vehicle. This
will change the handling characteristics. Oversized tires may also rub
against the fender over bumps,
causing vehicle damage or tire failure.
• After driving through water, test the
brakes while driving at a slow
speed to see if they have maintained their normal effectiveness. If
the brakes are less effective than
normal, dry them by repeatedly
applying the brakes while driving
slowly until the brakes have
regained their normal effectiveness.
Do’s and Dont’s for safe
driving
Exercise care in handling your vehicle. Be
conscious of not only your own safety but
also the safety of others on the road, and
thus enjoy the best and most comfortable
driving experience.
Following are basic rules for safe driving.
Read them carefully for good understanding of the content so that you can enjoy
safe and pleasant driving in your vehicle.
Starting
1) Adjust the driver’s seat for the proper
driving posture.
2) Adjust the rear view mirror so as to
obtain the best possible rear view.
EXAMPLE
72F-08-001
4-6
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
3) Before moving, look around your vehicle to confirm safety.
4) Don’t accelerate suddenly, since it is
dangerous and wastes fuel.
General Driving
1) Be sure to stop before a stop light or
stop sign. When moving into an intersection without any traffic lights or
signs, drive slowly to confirm safety.
2) Always follow other vehicles at a safe
distance in order to prevent a rear-end
collision, in case the vehicle ahead
makes a sudden stop.
EXAMPLE
5) When overtaking other vehicles, watch
out for oncoming vehicles and carefully
ensure safety.
6) Don’t attempt zigzag driving as it will
hinder your control over the vehicle and
may cause an accident.
7) Avoid reckless high speed driving and
try to drive at a safe speed suitable for
the road conditions while maintaining a
constant speed.
8) The higher the speed, the narrower the
driver’s visual range becomes. In such
a state, it is difficult to anticipate any
hazard and the driver feels fatigued.
Braking
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
72F-08-011
72F-08-008
3) Turn ON the turn signal at least 30
meters before making a turn or changing the lane so as not to be hit.
4) Before entering a corner, decelerate to
a safe speed. Don’t apply brakes during
cornering, or skidding may occur.
72F-08-015
9) Do not attempt sharp handling during
high speed driving. You may lose your
control over your vehicle.
10)When overtaking or changing lanes
while driving at a high speed, keep
ample vehicle-to-vehicle distance.
1) Use the parking brake when parking
your vehicle and shift the gear shift
lever into the first gear or reverse gear
position for the sake of safety.
2) Don’t use hand-braking unless unavoidable. It causes the vehicle to skid and a
collision may occur. It is especially dangerous when the tyres are worn out as
they skid more.
4-7
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Night Time Driving
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
72F-08-020
72F-08-012
Use foot brake in three stages
1. Warn the vehicle behind you.
2. Gradually apply the brake.
3. Bring the vehicle to a halt.
3) When driving downhill, try not to apply
the brake but use the engine brake
effectively. Overuse of the foot-brake
may result in reduction of brake effectiveness.
3) Don’t use headlights on high beam
unless its use is inevitable. It may cause
visual impairment to the driver of the
oncoming vehicle or the vehicle ahead
of you, which may cause an accident.
4) Always keep the window glasses clean.
Don’t operate the windshield wiper
when the windshield glass is dry else
the wiper blade and glass may get damaged.
1) Drive at lower speeds during the night
than in the daytime, as the visual range
is restricted at night.
2) Avoid overtaking other vehicles at night.
Darkness bothers your sense of speed
and hinders your judgment of vehicleto-vehicle distance.
EXAMPLE
Long Distance Driving
1) Be sure to perform safety checks before
starting a trip.
2) Take rest at regular intervals to prevent
accidents which may occur due to feeling sleepy or tired.
72F-08-021
4-8
66RH0-74E
DRIVING TIPS
Margin for safety
It is important to allow yourself a margin for
safety during driving so that you can cope
with erroneous or unexpected driving of
other drivers. For that, observe the following.
• Drive at a safe speed.
• Maintain a sufficient distance between
your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.
• Don’t force yourself to overtake other
vehicles.
• Don’t accelerate suddenly, steer sharply
or stop suddenly.
• Keep ample gaps between driving
schedules.
• Observe traffic rules and regulations.
Conclusion
A perfect driver does not exist. The
endeavour of every motorist should be to
strive for perfection. Safety consciousness
not only ensures your safety and the safety
of other road users, it also helps reduce
the wear and tear on your vehicle, lengthens its life, gives better fuel efficiency and
ensures a comfortable driving experience.
Follow the do’s and dont’s listed, and
driving will never be the same again.
4-9
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
60G407
Fuel filler cap ....................................................................... 5-1
Engine hood ........................................................................ 5-2
Sun visor .............................................................................. 5-4
Interior light ......................................................................... 5-5
Accessory socket ................................................................ 5-6
AUX/USB socket (if equipped) ........................................... 5-7
Assist grips .......................................................................... 5-7
Glove box ............................................................................. 5-7 5
Cup holder and storage area ............................................. 5-8
Footrest ................................................................................ 5-10
Floor mats (if equipped) ..................................................... 5-10
Luggage compartment cover (if equipped) ...................... 5-11
Luggage compartment board ............................................. 5-11
Frame hooks ........................................................................ 5-12
Heating and air conditioning system ................................ 5-14
Manual heating and air conditioning system ................... 5-15
Automatic heating and air conditioning system
(climate control) (if equipped) ............................................ 5-19
Radio antenna ..................................................................... 5-24
Installation of radio frequency transmitters ..................... 5-25
Audio system (if equipped) ................................................ 5-25
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Fuel filler cap
A fuel filler cap is located on the left rear
side of the vehicle. The fuel filler door can
be unlocked by pulling up the opener lever
located on the outboard side of the driver’s
seat and locked by simply closing the door.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(3)
Close
Open
(1)
(1)
(2)
75RM057
66RH147
EXAMPLE
(1)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
57L51093
To remove the fuel filler cap:
1) Open the fuel filler door.
2) Remove the cap by turning it counterclockwise.
CAUTION
Remove the fuel filler cap slowly. The
fuel may be under pressure and may
spray out, causing injury.
66RH050
(4)
75RM058
NOTE:
The cap holder (1) holds the fuel filler cap
(2) by hooking the groove (3), or the hook
(4) also holds the fuel filler cap when refueling.
5-1
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
To reinstall the fuel filler cap:
1) Turn the cap clockwise until you hear
several clicks.
2) Close the fuel filler door.
Engine hood
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Fuel is extremely flammable. Do not
smoke when refueling, and check
that there are no open flames or
sparks in the area.
WARNING
If you need to replace the fuel cap,
use a genuine MARUTI SUZUKI cap.
Use of an improper cap can result in
a malfunction of the fuel system or
emission control system. It may also
result in fuel leakage in the event of
an accident.
66RH148
66RH051
To open the engine hood:
1) Pull the hood release handle located on
the outboard side of the driver’s side.
This will disengage the engine hood
lock halfway.
2) Push the under-hood release lever
sideways with your finger, as shown in
the illustration. While pushing the lever,
lift up the engine hood.
CAUTION
The release lever can be hot enough
to burn your finger right after driving.
Touch the lever after it becomes cool
enough.
NOTICE
Check that the wiper arms are not
raised before you lift up the engine
hood to avoid damaging the wiper
arms and the engine hood.
5-2
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
EXAMPLE
To close the engine hood:
1) Lift the hood up slightly and remove the
prop rod from the hole. Put the prop rod
back into the holding clip.
EXAMPLE
CAUTION
To avoid injury, check that no part of
the occupant’s body such as hands
or head is in the path of the hood
when closing it.
NOTICE
Pressing the hood from above may
damage the hood.
66RH149
3) While holding the hood, pull the prop
rod out from the holding clip, and then
insert the end of the rod into the designated hole in the hood.
CAUTION
• The prop rod can be hot enough to
burn your finger right after driving.
Touch the rod after it becomes cool
enough.
• Insert the end of the rod into the
hole securely. If the rod slips out,
you may get caught in the closing
hood.
• The rod may slip out when the
hood is blown by wind. Be careful
on windy days.
66RH150
2) Lower the hood to about 20 cm above
the hood latch, and then let it drop
down. Check that the hood is securely
latched after closing.
WARNING
Check that the hood is fully closed
and latched before driving. If it is not,
it can fly up unexpectedly during
driving, obstructing your view and
resulting in an accident.
5-3
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Sun visor
Vanity mirror (if equipped)
Card holder (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
74LHT0516
79J161
The sun visors can be pulled down to block
glare coming through the windshield, or
they can be unhooked and turned to the
side to block glare coming through the side
window.
NOTICE
When unhooking and hooking a sun
visor, be sure to handle it by the hard
plastic parts or the sun visor can be
damaged.
(1) Card holder
You can put a card in the card holder (1) on
the back of the sun visor.
NOTICE
When you park your vehicle outdoors
in direct sunlight or in hot weather,
do not leave plastic cards in the
holder. The heat may distort them.
74LHT0532
(2) Vanity mirror
WARNING
When using the vanity mirror, do not
move too close to a front air bag
location or lean against it. If the front
air bag is accidentally inflated, it
could hit you hard.
5-4
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Interior light
Front
EXAMPLE
(3)
(2)
(1)
62R0294
These light switches have three or four
positions which function as described
below:
ON (1)
• The light comes on and stays on regardless of whether the door is open or
closed.
• To prevent battery from discharging, the
light will be automatically turned off
when a period of 15 minutes has
elapsed after the light comes on and
other operations are not done.
DOOR (2)
• The light comes on when any of the
doors (including the tailgate) is opened.
After closing all doors, the light will
remain on for about 15 seconds and
then fade out.
• If all doors are closed, the light comes on
for about 15 seconds when the ignition
key is pulled out from the ignition switch
or the engine switch is pressed to
change the ignition mode from ON to
LOCK (OFF). After 15 seconds, the light
will fade out.
• To prevent battery from discharging, the
light will be automatically turned off
when a period of 15 minutes has
elapsed after any of the doors (including
the tailgate) is opened and other operations are not done.
If you perform any of the following procedures before the light fading out, the light
will start to fade out immediately.
• Inserting the ignition key into the ignition
switch or pressing the engine switch to
change the ignition mode to ACC or ON.
• Locking all doors by operating the key,
keyless entry transmitter, keyless push
start system remote controller, power
door locking switch or request switch.
Courtesy light (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
66RH128
Each front door has a courtesy light on its
inside bottom. It lights automatically when
the door is opened.
NOTE:
If you leave any door open, the light will
automatically be turned off after about 15
minutes to prevent the battery from discharging.
OFF (3)
The light remains off even when the door is
opened.
5-5
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Luggage compartment (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
(1) (2)
Accessory socket
NOTICE
Do not leave the tailgate open with
the luggage compartment light
switch in ON position for a long time,
or the battery will discharge.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
75RM009
When you open the tailgate with the luggage compartment light switch in ON position (1), the light comes on and remains on
as long as you keep the tailgate open.
• To save the battery, the light will be automatically turned off when a period of 15
minutes has elapsed after the tailgate is
opened and other operations are not
done.
When the luggage compartment light
switch is in OFF position (2), the light
remains off regardless of whether the tailgate is open or close.
66RH129
75RM193
NOTE:
The number of doors involved in the lighting operation of the interior light depends
on the vehicle specification. If there is a
switch (rubber protrusion) at the door
opening as shown, the door is involved in
the lighting operation. The tailgate is also
involved in this operation even without the
rubber protrusion.
The accessory socket will work when the
ignition switch is in “ACC” or “ON” position,
or the ignition mode is ACC or ON.
This can be used to provide 12 volt/120
watt/10 ampere power for electrical accessories. Check that the cap is closed when
socket is not in use.
NOTICE
Use of inappropriate electrical accessories can cause damage to your
vehicle’s electrical system. Make
sure that any electrical accessories
you use are designed to plug into this
type of socket.
5-6
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
AUX/USB socket (if equipped)
Assist grips
Glove box
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RH130
Connect your portable digital music player,
etc. to this socket to enjoy music through
the vehicle’s audio system. Refer to “Audio
system” in this section.
54G249
Assist grips are provided for convenience.
NOTICE
66RH055
To open the glove box, pull the latch lever.
To close it, push the lid until it latches
securely.
To avoid damaging the assist grip
and the molded headlining, do not
hang down the assist grip.
5-7
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Cup holder and storage area
EXAMPLE
(4)
(1)
(3)
(4)
(6)
(2) (3)
(5)
(6)
EXAMPLE
66RH056
There is a recess in the glove box.
WARNING
Never drive with the glove box lid
open. It could cause injury if an accident occurs.
(4)
66RH057
(1) Center console tray
(3) Front bottle holder
(5) Front seat back pocket (if equipped)
(2) Front cup holders
(4) Rear cup holder
(6) Rear bottle holder
5-8
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Center console tray (1)
WARNING
Do not place any objects which may
fall out from the pocket when the
vehicle is moving. Failure to take the
precaution may result in an object
interfering with the pedals and causing a loss of vehicle control or an
accident.
Front cup holders (2) /
Rear cup holder (4)
Use the rear cup holder to put a cup with a
lid or a bottle with a cap. Also, you can put
small articles in the rear cup holder.
WARNING
Failure to take the precautions listed
below could cause personal injury or
vehicle damage.
• Be careful when you are using the
cup holders to hold a cup containing hot liquid. Spilling out hot liquid can cause burn injury.
• Do not use the cup holders to hold
sharp-edged, hard or breakable
objects. Objects in the cup holders
may be thrown about during a sudden stop or impact, and could
cause personal injury.
• Be careful not to spill liquid or
insert any foreign materials into the
moving part of the gearshift lever,
or any electrical components. Liquid or foreign materials may damage these parts.
Front bottle holder (3) /
Rear bottle holder (6)
You should only place a bottle with a cap in
the holder.
Front seat back pocket (5)
(if equipped)
EXAMPLE
66RH058
This pocket is provided for holding light
and soft things such as gloves, newspapers or magazines.
CAUTION
Do not put hard or breakable objects
in the pocket. If an accident occurs,
objects such as bottles, cans, etc.
can injure the occupants in the rear
seat.
5-9
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Footrest
Floor mats (if equipped)
WARNING
Failure to take the following precautions may result in the driver’s side
floor mat interfering with the pedals
and causing a loss of vehicle control
or an accident.
• Check that the floor mat grommets
are hooked to the fasteners.
• Never place additional floor mats
on top of the existing floor mat.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(1)
66RH059
72M10201
Use the footrest (1) as a support for your
left foot.
To prevent the driver’s side floor mat from
sliding forward and possibly interfering with
the operation of the pedals, MARUTI genuine floor mats are recommended.
Whenever you put the driver’s side floor
mat back in the vehicle after it has been
removed, hook the floor mat grommets to
the fasteners and position the floor mat
properly in the footwell.
When you replace the floor mats in your
vehicle with a different type such as all
weather floor mats, we highly recommend
to use MARUTI genuine floor mats for
proper fitting.
5-10
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Luggage compartment cover
(if equipped)
Luggage compartment board
CAUTION
If you are not careful when handling
the luggage board, you could be
injured.
Handle the luggage board carefully
when removing or installing it.
EXAMPLE
NOTICE
Do not apply undue force to the
board which is held open, and do not
hold open the board while driving.
Doing so could break the board or
the interior.
EXAMPLE
66RM05001
66RH060
Luggage or other cargo placed in the luggage compartment is hidden from view by
a luggage compartment cover.
WARNING
Do not carry items on top of the luggage compartment cover, even if they
are small and light. Objects on top of
the cover could be thrown about in
an accident, causing injury, or could
obstruct the driver’s rear view.
Your vehicle is equipped with the luggage
compartment board in the luggage compartment.
WARNING
Objects that extend higher than the
luggage compartment cover (if
equipped) can obstruct the driver’s
rear view, which can cause an accident. These objects can also become
damaged or can damage the tailgate.
Do not carry items that extend higher
than the luggage compartment cover.
5-11
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Frame hooks
Your MARUTI SUZUKI does not recommend you use the frame hooks for towing
another vehicle. MARUTI SUZUKI was
originally designed to tow your vehicle on
the road for emergency towing.
If your vehicle needs to be towed in an
emergency, refer to “Towing” in the
“EMERGENCY SERVICE” section.
Front
1) Pick up the towing hook (1), jack handle
(A) and wheel brace (B) in the luggage
compartment.
EXAMPLE
(1)
EXAMPLE
(C)
WARNING
Observe the following instructions
when using frame hooks. The towing
hook or vehicle body may break and
cause serious injury or damage:
• Do not use the frame hooks for
towing another vehicle.
• Avoid pulling the vehicle to get out
of severe snowy, muddy or sandy
conditions, sudden starts or erratic
driving maneuvers which could
cause excessive stress on the towing hook.
In such case, we recommend that
you contact a professional service.
75RM012
The towing hook (1) is provided on the
front of the vehicle for use in emergency
situations only.
To install the hook (1), follow the procedure
below.
EXAMPLE
(A)
75RM015
2) Remove the cover (C) by using a jack
handle (A) covered with a soft cloth as
shown in the illustration.
NOTE:
Do not use excessive force as it may damage the cover strap.
(1)
(A)
(B)
75RM014
5-12
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
EXAMPLE
4) To tighten the towing hook (1), turn it
clockwise by using a wheel brace (B)
until the hook (1) is securely installed.
(1)
To remove the towing hook (1), reverse the
installation procedure.
Other holes
EXAMPLE
Rear
EXAMPLE
(3)
75RM016
66RM05002
3) Install the towing hook (1) by hand.
NOTE:
We recommend that fasten the cover with
tape to prevent damage during towing.
The frame holes (3) are provided only for
transporting by a car carrier trailer.
(2)
WARNING
75RM018
EXAMPLE
The frame hook (2) is provided on the rear
of the vehicle for use in emergency situations and sea shipping purposes only.
(1)
(B)
(3)
Do not use the frame holes (3) for
towing purpose. These holes may
break and cause serious injury or
damage.
NOTICE
75RM017
When you use the frame hook (2),
avoid the driving that gives significant physical shock on hook. Such
operation can damage the hook, the
vehicle body or the drive system.
• Do not accelerate suddenly.
• Do not tow the vehicle heavier than
your vehicle.
5-13
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Heating and air conditioning system
Side outlet
There are two types of air conditioning systems as follows:
• Manual heating and air conditioning system (if equipped)
• Automatic heating and air conditioning system (climate control) (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Air outlet
EXAMPLE
1
1
2
2
3
4
3
4
75RM019
When open, air comes out regardless of
the air flow selector position.
5
5
66RH131
1. Windshield defroster outlet
2. Side defroster outlet
3. Side outlet
4. Center outlet
5. Floor outlet
5-14
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Manual heating and air conditioning system
Center outlet
Description of controls
(1)
(2)
EXAMPLE
(2)
(5)
EXAMPLE
66RH123
Move the knob (1) horizontally or the case
(2) vertically to adjust the direction of airflow as desired.
CAUTION
Prolonged exposure to hot air from
the heater or air conditioner could
result in low temperature burns. All
vehicle occupants, particularly children, the elderly, those with special
needs, individuals with delicate skin,
and sleeping individuals, should
maintain sufficient distance from the
air outlets to prevent prolonged
exposure to hot airflow.
(3)
(4)
(1)
75RM060
Temperature selector (1)
This is used to select the temperature by turning the selector.
Blower speed selector (2)
This is used to turn on the blower and to select blower speed by turning the selector.
5-15
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Air flow selector (3)
(c)
(b)
HEAT & DEFROST (d)
BI-LEVEL (b)
EXAMPLE
(d)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(a)
66RH133
(e)
75RM022
This is used to select one of the following
functions.
VENTILATION (a)
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out
of the center and side outlets. When the
temperature selector (1) is in the fully cold
position or fully hot position, however, the
air from the floor outlets and the air from
the center and side outlets will be the
same temperature.
66RH135
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the
side outlets.
DEFROST (e)
HEAT (c)
EXAMPLE
66RH136
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the windshield defroster outlets, the side
defroster outlets and the side outlets.
EXAMPLE
66RH132
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the center and side air outlets.
EXAMPLE
66RH134
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and the side outlets, also
comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and also comes slightly out of the side
defroster outlets.
5-16
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Air conditioning switch (5)
To turn on the air conditioning system, set
the blower speed selector to a position
other than off and push in “A/C” switch (5).
With this “A/C” switch operation, a indicator light will come on when the air conditioning system is on. To turn off the air
conditioning system, push “A/C” switch
again.
Air intake selector (4)
EXAMPLE
(g)
(f)
75RM059
This selector is used to select the following
modes.
FRESH AIR (f)
When this mode is selected by moving the
lever to right, outside air is used.
RECIRCULATED AIR (g)
When this mode is selected by moving the
lever to left, outside air is shut out and
inside air is recirculated. This mode is suitable when driving through dusty or polluted
air such as in a tunnel, or when attempting
to quickly cool down the interior.
NOTE:
If you select RECIRCULATED AIR for an
extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore,
you should occasionally select FRESH
AIR.
During operation of the air conditioner, you
may notice slight changes in engine
speed. These changes are normal, the
system is designed so that the compressor
turns on or off to maintain the desired temperature.
Less operation of the compressor results
in better fuel economy.
System operating instructions
Natural ventilation
Select VENTILATION and FRESH AIR, the
temperature selector to the desired temperature position, and the blower speed
selector to off. Fresh air will flow through
the vehicle during driving.
Forced ventilation
The control settings are the same as for
natural ventilation except you set the
blower speed selector to a position other
than off.
Normal heating (using outside air)
Select HEAT and FRESH AIR, the temperature selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed selector
to the desired blower speed position. Setting the blower speed selector to a higher
blower speed position increases heating
efficiency.
Quick heating (using recirculated air)
The control settings are the same as for
normal heating except you select RECIRCULATED AIR. If you use this heating
method for an extended period of time, the
air in the vehicle can become contaminated and the windows can become misty.
Therefore, use this method only for quick
heating and change to the normal heating
method as soon as possible.
5-17
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Head cooled/Feet warmed heating
Select BI-LEVEL and FRESH AIR, the
temperature selector to the desired temperature position, and the blower speed
selector to the desired blower speed position. Unless the temperature selector is in
the fully cold position or fully hot position,
the air that comes out of the center and
side outlets will be cooler than the air that
comes out of the floor outlets.
Normal cooling
Set the air flow selector to VENTILATION,
the temperature selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed
selector to the desired blower speed position, and turn on “A/C” switch. Setting the
blower speed selector to a higher blower
speed position increases cooling efficiency.
You can switch the air intake selector to
either FRESH AIR or RECIRCULATED
AIR as you desire. Choosing RECIRCULATED AIR increases cooling efficiency.
Quick cooling (using recirculated air)
The control settings are the same as for
normal cooling except you select RECIRCULATED AIR and the highest blower
speed.
NOTE:
• If you select RECIRCULATED AIR for an
extended period of time, the air in the
vehicle can become contaminated.
Therefore, you should occasionally
select FRESH AIR.
• If your vehicle has been left in the sun
with the windows closed, it will cool
faster if you open the windows briefly
while you operate the air conditioner with
the air intake selector at FRESH AIR and
the blower at high speed.
Dehumidifying
Set the air flow selector to a desired air
flow selector position, the temperature
selector to the desired temperature position and the blower speed selector to the
desired blower speed position. Also select
FRESH AIR and turn on “A/C” switch.
NOTE:
Because the air conditioner dehumidifies
the air, turning it on will help keep the windows clear, even when blowing heated air
using DEFROST or HEAT & DEFROST
functions.
EXAMPLE
66RH137
NOTE:
If you need maximum defrosting:
• select DEFROST and FRESH AIR,
• set the blower speed selector to high,
• adjust the temperature selector to the
hot end,
• turn on “A/C” switch, and
• adjust the side outlets so the air blows
on the side windows.
5-18
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Maintenance
If you do not use the air conditioner for a
long period, such as during winter, it may
not give the best performance when you
start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.
Operate the air conditioner at least once a
month for one minute with the engine
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil
and helps protect the internal components.
Automatic heating and air conditioning system
(climate control) (if equipped)
Description of controls
EXAMPLE
(1)
(9)
(2)
If your air conditioner is equipped with air
filters, clean or replace them as specified
in “Maintenance schedule” in the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Have this job done by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop as the lower glove
box must be lowered for this job.
NOTE:
Your vehicle uses the air conditioning
refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called
R-134a. R-134a replaced R-12 around
1993 for automotive applications. Other
refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used
in your vehicle.
NOTICE
Using the wrong refrigerant may
damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or
replace the R-134a with other refrigerants.
(3)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(5)
(4)
75RM025
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(9)
Temperature selector
Blower speed selector
Air intake selector
Air flow selector
Defrost switch
Air conditioning switch
“OFF” switch
“AUTO” switch
Display
5-19
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Blower speed selector (2)
Temperature selector (1)
Air intake selector (3)
EXAMPLE
(1)
(2)
(3)
(a)
EXAMPLE
(b)
EXAMPLE
75RM026
75RM027
75RM028
Push the temperature selector (1) up or
down to adjust the temperature.
The blower speed selector (2) is used to
turn on the blower and to select blower
speed.
Push the air intake selector (3) to change
between the following modes.
NOTE:
If you push the temperature selector (1)
until “HI” or “LO” appears on the display,
the climate control system will operate at
maximum heating or cooling. The temperature of the air from the outlets may change
suddenly while “LO” or “HI” is displayed,
but this is normal.
NOTE:
When you change the unit of temperature
in the information display, the unit of temperature in the air conditioning system will
be changed. Refer to “Information display
(instrument cluster with tachometer)” in the
“BEFORE DRIVING” section for details.
If “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the blower
speed will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the
selected temperature.
If “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air
intake will vary automatically as the climate
control system maintains the selected temperature.
NOTE:
When you select the recirculated air mode,
the automatic operation system is deactivated if you push “AUTO” switch (8).
RECIRCULATED AIR (a)
When this mode is selected, outside air is
shut off and inside air is recirculated. This
mode is suitable when driving through an
area with polluted air such as a tunnel, or
when attempting to quickly cool down the
vehicle.
5-20
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
FRESH AIR (b)
When this mode is selected, outside air is
introduced.
FRESH AIR and RECIRCULATED AIR are
selected alternately each time the air
intake selector is pushed.
NOTE:
If you select RECIRCULATED AIR for an
extended period of time, the air in the vehicle can become contaminated. Therefore,
you should occasionally select FRESH
AIR.
Air flow selector (4)
VENTILATION (c)
EXAMPLE
(c)
(d)
(4)
(e)
66RH132
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the center, side and rear air outlets.
(f)
EXAMPLE
75RM029
Push the air flow selector (4) to change
among the following functions. The indication of the selected mode appears on the
display.
If “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air flow
will vary automatically as the climate control system maintains the selected temperature.
BI-LEVEL (d)
EXAMPLE
66RH133
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out
of the center, side and rear outlets. When
the temperature selector (1) is in the fully
cold position or fully hot position, however,
the air from the floor outlets and the air
from the center, side and rear outlets will
be the same temperature.
5-21
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Air conditioning switch (6)
Defrost switch (5)
HEAT (e)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(6)
(5)
EXAMPLE
66RH134
75RM030
75RM031
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets and the side outlets, a
small amount of air comes out of the windshield defroster outlets and also comes
slightly out of the side defroster outlets.
Push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the
defroster.
The air conditioning switch (6) is used to
turn on and off the air conditioning system
only when the blower is on. To turn on the
air conditioning system, push in the switch
and “A/C” will appear on the display. To
turn off the air conditioning system, push in
the switch again and “A/C” will go off.
DEFROST
HEAT & DEFROST (f)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RH136
66RH138
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the
side outlets.
Temperature-controlled air comes out of
the windshield defroster outlets, the side
defroster outlets and the side outlets.
NOTE:
When the defrost switch (5) is pushed to
turn on the defroster, the air conditioning
system will come on and FRESH AIR
mode will be selected automatically. In
very cold weather, however, the air conditioning system will not turn on.
5-22
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
System operating instructions
You can use the air conditioning switch (6)
to manually turn the air conditioner on or off
according to your preference. When you
turn the air conditioning switch off, the climate control system cannot lower the inside
temperature below outside temperature.
Automatic operation
To turn the climate control system off, push
“OFF” switch (7).
(1)
EXAMPLE
(6)
(7)
(8)
75RM032
You can let the climate control system work
automatically. To set the system for fully-automatic operation, follow the procedure below.
1) Start the engine.
2) Push “AUTO” switch (8).
3) Set the desired temperature by pushing
the temperature selector (1).
The blower speed, air intake and air flow
are controlled automatically to maintain the
set temperature. However, the air flow is
not changed to DEFROST position automatically.
NOTE:
When you select the recirculated air mode,
the automatic operation system is deactivated if you push “AUTO” switch (8).
NOTE:
If “AUTO” on the display blinks, there is a
problem in the heating system and/or air
conditioning system. You should have the
system inspected by an authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
NOTE:
• To find the temperature at which you are
most comfortable, start with the 25°C
(75°F) setting.
• If you push the temperature selector (1)
until “HI” or “LO” appears on the display,
the climate control system will operate at
maximum heating or cooling and the
blower will run at full speed.
• To avoid blowing cold air in cold weather
or hot air in hot weather, the system will
delay turning on the blower until warmed
or chilled air is available.
• If your vehicle has been left in the sun
with the windows closed, it will cool
faster if you open the windows briefly.
• Even under the automatic operation, you
can set individual selectors to the manual
mode. The manually selected functions
are maintained, and the other functions
remain under automatic operation.
• If the windshield and/or the front door
windows are fogged, push the defrost
switch (5) to turn on the defroster, or
push the air flow selector (4) to change
the air flow to HEAT & DEFROST position to defog the windows.
• To return the blower speed selector (2),
air intake selector (3), and air flow selector (4) to automatic operation, push
“AUTO” switch (8).
EXAMPLE
(11)
(10)
66RH124
Be careful not to cover the interior temperature sensor (10) located between the
steering wheel and the climate control
panel, or the solar sensor (11) located at
the top of the driver’s side dashboard.
These sensors are used by the automatic
system to regulate temperature.
5-23
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Manual operation
You can manually control the climate control system. Set the selectors to the
desired positions.
EXAMPLE
66RH137
NOTE:
If you need maximum defrosting:
• push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the
defroster (the air conditioning system will
come on and FRESH AIR mode will be
selected automatically),
• set the blower speed selector to high,
• adjust the temperature selector to “HI”
indication on the display, and
• adjust the side outlets so the air blows
on the side windows.
Maintenance
If you do not use the air conditioner for a
long period, such as during winter, it may
not give the best performance when you
start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.
Operate the air conditioner at least once a
month for one minute with the engine
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil
and helps protect the internal components.
If your air conditioner is equipped with air
filters, clean or replace them as specified
in “Maintenance schedule” in the
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section. Have this job done by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop as the lower glove
box must be lowered for this job.
NOTE:
Your vehicle uses the air conditioning
refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called
R-134a. R-134a replaced R-12 around
1993 for automotive applications. Other
refrigerants are available, including recycled R-12, but only R-134a should be used
in your vehicle.
NOTICE
Using the wrong refrigerant may
damage your air conditioning system. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or
replace the R-134a with other refrigerants.
Radio antenna
EXAMPLE
75RM301
The radio antenna on the roof is removable. To remove the antenna, turn it counterclockwise. To reinstall the antenna, turn
it clockwise firmly by hand.
NOTICE
To avoid damage to the radio
antenna:
• Remove the antenna when using an
automatic car wash.
• Remove the antenna when the
antenna hits anything such as a
low ceiling in a parking garage or
putting a car cover over your vehicle.
5-24
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Installation of radio frequency
transmitters
We recommend that you always ask a
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop about
frequency band, max output power,
antenna position at vehicle and specific
conditions for installation and/or use before
installing a radio transmitter in your vehicle. Such equipments may cause the electronic control system to malfunction if they
are incorrectly installed or they are not
suited for the vehicle.
Audio system (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
66RH070
AM/FM CD player with Bluetooth® function
NOTE:
For vehicle equipped with SMARTPLAY INFOTAINMENT SYSTEM, refer to the audio
manual available with the vehicle.
5-25
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Safety information
WARNING
If you pay too much attention to
operating the audio system or viewing the audio system display while
driving, an accident can occur. If
you set the sound volume too loud,
it could prevent you from being
aware of road and traffic conditions.
• Keep your eyes on the road and
your mind on the drive. Avoid paying too much attention to operating the audio system or viewing
the audio system display.
• Familiarize yourself with the audio
system controls and operation of
the audio system before driving.
• Preset your favorite radio stations
before driving so that you can
quickly tune to them using the
presets.
• Set the sound volume to a level
that will allow you to continue to
be aware of road and traffic conditions while driving.
Notes on discs
Cautions on handling
Precautions
• When the inside of the vehicle is very
cold and the player is used soon after
switching on the heater, condensation
may form on the disc or the optical
parts of the player and proper playback
may not be possible. If condensation
forms on the disc, wipe it off with a soft
cloth. If condensation forms on the optical parts of the player, do not use the
player for about one hour. This will
allow the condensation to disappear
normally.
• Driving on extremely bumpy roads
which cause severe vibrations may
cause sound to skip.
• This unit uses a precision mechanism.
Even in the event that trouble arises,
never open the case, disassemble the
unit, or lubricate the rotating parts.
Bring the unit to an authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
EXAMPLE
(A)
52D274
This unit has been designed specifically for
playback of compact discs bearing mark
(A) shown above.
No other discs can be played.
Removing the disc Proper way to hold
the compact disc
EXAMPLE
52D275
To remove the compact disc from its storage case, press down on the center of the
case and lift the disc out, holding it carefully by the edges.
Always handle the compact disc by the
edges.
Never touch the surface.
5-26
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
EXAMPLE
Use of such discs will cause damage or
prevent the system from operating properly.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
52D347
To remove fingermarks and dust, use a
soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from
the center of the compact disc to the circumference.
(B)
(C)
52D348
Never stick labels on the surface of the
compact disc or write on the surface with a
pencil or pen.
52D351
Do not expose compact discs to direct sunlight or any heat source.
EXAMPLE
(B)
52D349
Do not use any solvents such as commercially available cleaners, anti-static spray,
or thinner to clean compact discs.
EXAMPLE
52D277
New discs may have some roughness
around the edges. The unit may not work
or the sound may skip if such discs are
used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to
remove the roughness (C) from edges of
the disc before inserting it into the unit.
EXAMPLE
52D350
Do not use compact discs that have large
scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc.
5-27
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
• Do not use commercially available CD
protection sheets or discs equipped with
stabilizers, etc.
These may get caught in the internal
mechanism and damage the disc.
• It may be impossible to play CD-R discs
with this unit due to the recording conditions.
• CD-RW discs cannot be played with this
unit.
WARNING
This is a class I laser product. Use
of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures other than
those specified herein may result in
hazardous radiation exposure.
Do not open covers and do not
attempt to repair this unit by yourself.
Ask an authorized dealer for the
repair.
The Bluetooth® word mark and logo are
registered trademarks and are owned by
the Bluetooth SIG, Ink.
Stop using this unit and a Bluetooth®
ready device whenever requested.
This unit shares the communication frequency with other private or public wireless
communication equipment such as a wireless LAN and other wireless communication radios.
You should stop using this unit whenever
you are notified that your unit disturbs
other wireless communication immediately.
5-28
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Basic operations
Turning on/off power
Press “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1) to turn
on the power. The unit starts to operate in
the previous setting that the power was
turned off.
EXAMPLE
Adjusting the volume
Turn “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1).
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;
turning it counterclockwise decreases the
volume.
(2)
NOTE:
For the purposes of safe driving, adjust the
audio volume to a level that allows you to
hear sounds outside of the vehicle including car horns and particularly emergency
vehicle sirens.
(1)
66RH071
(1) “VOL PUSH PWR” knob
(2) “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
5-29
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader
1) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (2).
Each time the knob is pressed, sound
adjustment will change as follows:
Preset-EQ (EQ OFF)
Bass adjustment (BASS 0)
Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0)
Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0)
Fader adjustment (FADER 0)
AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2)
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to adjust the sound.
Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume control)
The Auto Volume Control (AVC) function
automatically
adjusts
(increases/
decreases) the sound volume in accordance with vehicle speed. The AVC control
is provided with three selectable levels
(LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume
adjustment increases together with the
LEVEL number.
1) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode
is selected.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select the desired AVC adjustment level (Initial setting: LEVEL 2).
Preset-EQ
Preset-EQ calls up various sound types in
accordance with the listening music type.
1) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (2) several times until “PRESETEQ” appears.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2).
Each time the knob is turned, preset
EQ mode will change as follows:
OFF (FLAT)
JAZZ
ROCK
POP
CLASSIC
HIP-HOP
5-30
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to the radio
Display
(A)
EXAMPLE
(B)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(1)
(2)
(7)
“FM” button
“AM” button
UP button
DOWN button
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
PRESET buttons ([1] to [6])
“AS” button
(A) Band
(B) Frequency
(5)
(6)
66RH072
5-31
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting the FM band
Press “FM” button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the reception band will change as follows:
FM1
FM2
Selecting the AM band
Press “AM” button (2).
Seek tuning
Press UP button (3) or DOWN button (4).
The unit stops searching for a station at a
frequency where a broadcast station is
available.
Manual tuning
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob (5).
The frequency being received is displayed.
Auto store
Hold down “AS” button (7) for 2 seconds or
longer.
6 stations in good reception will automatically be stored to PRESET buttons (6) in
order, starting from a station whose frequency is the lowest.
NOTE:
• Auto store can be released by pressing
“AS” button (7) while auto store is under
way.
• When the auto store is performed, the
station previously stored in the memory
at the position is overwritten.
• When there are fewer than 6 stations
that can be stored even if 1 round of
auto store operation is performed, no
station will be stored at the remaining
PRESET buttons (6).
• 6 stations can be preset for FM1 and
FM2 in common, and 6 stations for AM
in auto store mode.
Auto store mode on/off
Press “AS” button (7).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
is switched as follows:
AS mode on
AS mode off
Radio reception
Radio reception can be affected by environment, atmospheric conditions, or radio
signal’s power and distance from the station. Nearby mountains and buildings may
interfere or deflect radio reception, causing
poor reception. Poor reception or radio
static can also be caused by electric current from overhead wires or high voltage
power lines.
Preset memory
1) Select the desired station.
2) Hold down a desired button ([1] to [6])
of the PRESET buttons (6) to which you
want to store the station for 2 seconds
or longer.
5-32
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to a CD
Display
(A)
EXAMPLE
(1)
(B)
(2)
(4)
(5)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(3)
Insertion slot
EJECT button
“CD” button
UP button
DOWN button
“RPT” button
“RDM” button
“DISP” button
(A) Track number
(B) Play time
NOTE:
This product does not support 8 cm CD
(sometimes called as “mini single CD”, “3inch CD”, “CD3”, etc.).
(8) (6) (7)
66RH073
5-33
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
EXAMPLE
(A)
• CDs or CD-ROMs without mark (A) cannot be used.
• Some discs recorded in CD-R/CD-RW
format may sometimes be impossible to
use.
EXAMPLE
• A CD is to be inserted with its label side
up.
• When there is a CD already in the unit, it
is impossible to insert another CD without ejecting the CD in the unit. Do not
use force to insert a CD into the CD
insertion slot.
NOTICE
NOTICE
• Never insert your finger or hand
into the CD insertion slot. Never
insert foreign objects.
• Never insert a CD with glue coming
out from adhesive tape or a rental
CD label or with a trace indicating
that adhesive tape or a rental CD
label has been removed. This may
cause the CD not to eject or result
in a malfunction.
If you forcefully try to push an
ejected CD inside the unit before auto
reloading, the disc surface might be
scratched.
Before reloading a CD, remove it
from the unit completely.
Loading a CD
Insert a CD in the insertion slot (1).
When the CD is loaded, it starts to play.
Ejecting a CD
Press EJECT button (2).
When the ignition switch is in “LOCK” position or the engine switch is in LOCK (OFF)
mode, the CD remained ejected for around
15 seconds or longer will automatically be
drawn inside the unit (Auto reload function).
The backup eject function:
This function allows you to eject a CD by
pressing EJECT button (2) even when the
ignition switch is in “LOCK” position or the
engine switch is in LOCK (OFF) mode.
Listening to a CD
When a CD is inserted, playback will automatically start.
When a CD is already inside the unit,
press “CD” button (3) to start playback.
Selecting a track
• Press UP button (4) to listen to the next
track.
• Press DOWN button (5) twice to listen to
the previous track.
When DOWN button (5) is pressed
once, the track currently being played
will start from the beginning again.
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• Hold down UP button (4) to fast forward
the track.
• Hold down DOWN button (5) to fast
rewind the track.
5-34
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Random playback
Press “RDM” button (7).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
TRACK RANDOM
Display change
Press “DISP” button (8).
Each time the button is pressed, display
will change as follows:
Play time
Disc title
Track title
• TRACK RANDOM
The random indicator “RDM” will light.
The tracks in the loaded disc will be
played in random order.
Repeat playback
Press “RPT” button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
NOTE:
• “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there
is no text information in the disc currently
being played.
• If text data contains more than 16 characters, “>” mark will appear at the right
end. Holding down “DISP” button (8) for
1 second or longer can display the next
page.
TRACK REPEAT
• TRACK REPEAT
The repeat indicator “RPT” will light.
The track currently being played will be
played repeatedly.
5-35
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to an MP3/WMA/AAC disc
Display
(A)
EXAMPLE
(D)
(2)
(3)
(1)
(B)
(C)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
UP button
DOWN button
“RPT” button
“RDM” button
“DISP” button
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Folder number
Track number
Play time
File type
(6) (4) (5)
66RH074
5-36
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting a folder
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob (1)
to select a folder.
Selecting a track
• Press UP button (2) to listen to the next
track.
• Press DOWN button (3) twice to listen to
the previous track.
When DOWN button (3) is pressed
once, the track currently being played
will start from the beginning again.
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• Hold down UP button (2) to fast forward
the track.
• Hold down DOWN button (3) to fast
rewind the track.
Random playback
Press “RDM” button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
FOLDER RANDOM
ALL RANDOM
• FOLDER RANDOM
The random indicator “F.RDM” will light.
The tracks in the current folder will be
played in random order.
• ALL RANDOM
The random indicator “RDM” will light.
The tracks in the loaded disc will be
played in random order.
Repeat playback
Press “RPT” button (4).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
FILE REPEAT
FOLDER REPEAT
• FILE REPEAT
The repeat indicator “RPT” will light.
The track currently being played will be
played repeatedly.
• FOLDER REPEAT
The repeat indicator “F.RPT” will light.
All tracks in the currently selected folder
will be played repeatedly.
5-37
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Display change
Press “DISP” button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, display
will change as follows:
Play time
Folder name
File name
Album name (MP3, AAC only)
Track title
Artist name
NOTE:
• “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there
is no text information in the disc currently
being played.
• If text data contains more than 16 characters, “>” mark will appear at the right
end. Holding down “DISP” button (6) for
1 second or longer can display the next
page.
Notes on MP3/WMA/AAC
What is MP3?
• An abbreviation of “MPEG audio layer3”,
MP3 is an audio compression format
that has become the standard format
among PC users. Its merit is that the
original audio data is compressed to
approximately 1/10 and high sound quality is maintained. This means that it is
possible to store the data of approximately 10 music CDs on a single CD-R/
RW disc, which in turn makes it possible
to play music for a long time without having to change the disc.
What is WMA?
• An abbreviation of “Windows Media
Audio,” WMA is an audio compression
format developed by Microsoft.
• WMA files for which the DRM (Digital
Rights Management) function is on cannot be played.
• Windows MediaTM and the Windows®
logo are trademarks or registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the
United States and other countries.
Points to remember when making
MP3/WMA/AAC files
Common
• High bit rate and high sampling frequency are recommended for high quality sounds.
• Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not
recommended. Selecting VBR may
cause display of incorrect playing time
and jumpiness of playback.
• Playback sound quality varies depending on the encoding environment. For
details, refer to the user manual of the
encoding software and the writing software in use.
NOTICE
Never use “.mp3”, “.wma” or “.m4a”
as a file name extension if it is not in
the MP3/WMA/AAC format file. Failure to observe this may result in
damage to the speaker due to noise
production.
What is AAC?
• An abbreviation of “Advanced Audio
Coding,” AAC is an audio compression
format used by MPEG2 and MPEG4.
5-38
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Recording MP3/WMA/AAC files on a CD
media
• It is recommended not to write both CDDA files and MP3/WMA/AAC files on a
disc.
• If both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA/AAC
files are on the same disc, tracks may
not be played in the correct order or
some tracks may not be played at all.
• When storing both MP3 data and WMA
data on the same disc, sort and place
them in different folders.
• Do not write files other than MP3/WMA/
AAC files and unnecessary folders on a
disc.
• MP3/WMA/AAC files should be named
to meet the standards and the file system specifications as shown below.
• The file extension “.mp3”, “.wma” or
“.m4a” should be assigned to files based
on their format independently.
• You may encounter a trouble in playing
MP3/WMA/AAC files or displaying information of MP3/WMA/AAC files depending on the writing software or CD
recorder in use.
• This unit does not have a playlist function.
• It is recommended to write discs in Discat-Once mode even though Multi-session mode is supported. These modes
are the methods for writing audio data in
CD.
Compression formats
MP3
• Bit rate:
MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k - 320 kbps
MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps
MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps
• Sampling frequency:
MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k/44.1 k/
48 kHz
MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 16 k/22.05 k/
24 kHz
MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k/11.025 k/
12 kHz
WMA (Ver. 7, Ver. 8, Ver. 9*)
• Bit rate: CBR 32 k - 320 kbps
• Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz
* WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are
not supported.
AAC*
• Bit rate: ABR 16 k - 320 kbps
• Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz
* Apple Lossless is not supported.
Supported file systems
ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Joliet, Romeo
Maximum number of files/folders
• Maximum number of files: 512
• Maximum number of files in a folder: 255
• Maximum depth of tree structure: 8
• Maximum number of folders: 255
(Root folder is included.)
5-39
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to files stored in a USB device
Display
(A)
EXAMPLE
(D)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
(B)
(C)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
“MEDIA” button
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
UP button
DOWN button
“RPT” button
“RDM” button
“DISP” button
(A)
(B)
(C)
(D)
Folder number
Track number
Play time
File type
NOTICE
(7) (5) (6)
66RH075
Do not connect any USB device other
than a USB memory or a USB audio
player. Do not connect multiple USB
devices to the USB connector using a
USB hub, etc. Supplying power to
multiple USB devices from the connector could cause overheating and
smoking.
5-40
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting a USB device mode
Press “MEDIA” button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
USB (iPod®) (if equipped)
Bluetooth®
Random playback
Press “RDM” button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
FOLDER RANDOM
ALL RANDOM
audio (if equipped)
• FOLDER REPEAT
The repeat indicator “F.RPT” will light.
All the tracks in the folder currently
selected will be played repeatedly.
Display change
Press “DISP” button (7).
Each time the button is pressed, display
will change as follows:
AUX (if equipped)
Selecting a folder
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob (2)
to select the desired folder.
Selecting a track
• Press UP button (3) to listen to the next
track.
• Press DOWN button (4) twice to listen to
the previous track.
When DOWN button (4) is pressed
once, the track currently being played
will start from the beginning again.
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• Hold down UP button (3) to fast forward
the track.
• Hold down DOWN button (4) to fast
rewind the track.
• FOLDER RANDOM
The random indicator “F.RDM” will light.
The tracks in the currently selected
folder will be played in random order.
• ALL RANDOM
The random indicator “RDM” will light.
The tracks in the connected USB device
will be played in random order.
Repeat playback
Press “RPT” button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
FILE REPEAT
FOLDER REPEAT
• FILE REPEAT
The repeat indicator “RPT” will light.
The track currently being played will be
played repeatedly.
Play time
Folder name
File name
Album name (MP3, AAC only)
Track title
Artist name
NOTE:
• “NO TITLE” will be displayed when there
is no text information in the file currently
being played.
• If text data contains more than 16 characters, “>” mark will appear at the right
end. Holding down “DISP” button (7) for
1 second or longer can display the next
page.
5-41
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Notes on USB device
Compatible USB devices
• USB mass storage class.
For details as to whether your USB
memory/USB audio is compatible with
USB mass storage class, please contact
the USB memory/USB audio manufacturer.
• USB standard compatibility 1.1/2.0 full
speed.
• File system FAT12/16/32, VFAT.
• Maximum current less than 1.0 A.
• If devices such as USB hub, extension
cable are connected to the audio system, it may not be recognized. In such
case, connect the USB device directly to
the audio system.
• Devices such as MP3 player/mobile
phone/digital camera may not be recognized by the audio system for playing
music.
USB device connection
• When connecting a USB device, check
that the connector is pushed all the way
into the port.
• Do not leave the USB device for long
periods of time inside the vehicle where
the temperature can rise too high.
• Back up any important data beforehand.
We cannot accept responsibility for any
lost data.
• It is recommended not to connect a USB
device that contains data files other than
MP3/WMA/AAC format.
Recording MP3/WMA/AAC files on a
USB device
• Playback or display may not be possible
depending on the type of USB device in
use or the condition of the recording.
• Depending on the connected USB memory, the files may be played in different
order from the stored one.
Compression formats
MP3
• Bit rate:
MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k - 320 kbps
MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps
MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k - 160 kbps
• Sampling frequency:
MPEG1 Audio Layer III: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz
MPEG2 Audio Layer III: 16 k/22.05 k/24 kHz
MPEG2.5 Audio Layer III: 8 k/11.025 k/12 kHz
WMA (Ver. 7, Ver. 8, Ver. 9*)
• Bit rate: CBR 32 k - 320 kbps
• Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz
* WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice are
not supported.
AAC*
• Bit rate: ABR 16 k - 320 kbps
• Sampling frequency: 32 k/44.1 k/48 kHz
* Apple Lossless is not supported.
Maximum number of files/folders
• Maximum number of files: 2500
• Maximum number of files in a folder: 255
• Maximum depth of tree structure: 8
• Maximum number of folders: 255
(Root folder is included.)
5-42
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Listening to an iPod®
Display
(A)
EXAMPLE
(7) (5) (6)
(B)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(C)
“MEDIA” button
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
UP button
DOWN button
“RPT” button
“RDM” button
“DISP” button
PRESET buttons ([1] to [6])
(A) Track title
(B) Track number
(C) Play time
(2)
(8)
66RH076
5-43
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selecting an iPod® mode
Press “MEDIA” button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
USB (iPod®) (if equipped)
Random playback
Press “RDM” button (6).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
SONG RANDOM
ALBUM RANDOM
Bluetooth® audio (if equipped)
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• Hold down UP button (3) to fast forward
the track.
• Hold down DOWN button (4) to fast
rewind the track.
Playlist name /
Track title (Playlist mode only)
Artist name /
Track title
AUX (if equipped)
Selecting a track
• Press UP button (3) to listen to the next
track.
• Press DOWN button (4) twice to listen to
the previous track.
When DOWN button (4) is pressed
once, the track currently being played
will start from the beginning again.
Display change
Press “DISP” button (7).
Each time the button is pressed, display
will change as follows:
• SONG RANDOM
The random indicator “RDM” will light.
The tracks in the iPod® will be played in
random order.
• ALBUM RANDOM
The random indicator “F.RDM” will light.
The albums in the iPod® will be played in
random order.
Repeat playback
Press “RPT” button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
OFF
Album name /
Track title
Track title /
Play time
NOTE:
If text data contains more than 16 characters, “>” mark will appear at the right end.
Holding down “DISP” button (7) for 1 second or longer can display the next page.
SONG REPEAT
• SONG REPEAT
The repeat indicator “RPT” will light.
The track currently being played will be
played repeatedly.
5-44
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Playing mode selection
1) Press the button numbered [6] of PRESET buttons (8) for 1 second or longer.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2).
Each time the knob is turned, the mode
will change as follows:
PLAYLIST
ARTIST
ALBUM
SONGS
PODCAST
GENRE
AUDIOBOOK
3) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (2) to select the desired mode.
NOTE:
• When the button numbered [6] of PRESET buttons (8) is pressed, the previous
mode will be displayed.
Notes on iPod®
Supported iPod®
• iPod® touch (6th generation)
• iPod® touch (5th generation)
• iPod® touch (4th generation)
• iPod® touch (3rd generation)
• iPod® touch (2nd generation)
• iPod® touch (1st generation)
• iPod® classic
• iPod® nano (7th generation)
• iPod® nano (6th generation)
• iPod® nano (5th generation)
• iPod® nano (4th generation)
• iPod® nano (3rd generation)
• iPod® nano (2nd generation)
• iPod® nano (1st generation)
• iPod® (5th generation)
• iPhone® 6S Plus
• iPhone® 6S
• iPhone® 6 Plus
• iPhone® 6
• iPhone® 5S
• iPhone® 5C
• iPhone® 5
• iPhone® 4S
• iPhone® 4
• iPhone® 3GS
• iPhone® 3G
• iPhone®
* Some functions may not be available
depending on the model of iPod®.
* iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
* iPhone® is a trademark of Apple Inc.,
registered in the U.S. and other countries.
* Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance with
safety and regulatory standards.
iPod® connection
• Make sure to detach the iPod® after
turning the ignition switch to “LOCK”
position or pressing the engine switch to
change the ignition mode to LOCK
(OFF). The iPod® may not be shut down
when it is being connected and may
result in battery depletion.
• Do not connect iPod® accessories such
as an iPod® remote control or headphones while connecting the iPod® with
the unit. The unit may not operate correctly.
5-45
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
AUX function
AUX connection
To listen to auxiliary audio sources (sold
separately) through the unit, follow the
instruction below.
1) Connect the auxiliary audio source to
the AUX/USB socket (separately
attached) with an AUX cable.
2) Press “MEDIA” button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the
mode will change as follows:
EXAMPLE
USB (iPod®) (if equipped)
(1)
Bluetooth® audio (if equipped)
AUX (if equipped)
CAUTION
66RH077
(1) “MEDIA” button
• Before connection, mute the unit,
and also keep the volume of the
auxiliary audio source within a
range that will not cause distortion.
• When the audio source is turned
off, noise may be emitted. Be sure
to turn off the unit or switch to
another mode before turning off the
audio source.
5-46
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
NOTE:
• Please consult your place of purchase
for details about whether a given auxiliary audio source can be connected and
the proper auxiliary cord to use.
• The volume and tone controls of the
auxiliary audio source can be adjusted
on the unit.
• In AUX mode, the volume setting is different from another mode.
5-47
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Bluetooth® hands-free (if equipped)
Steering switch
EXAMPLE
(10)
(9)
(7)
(8)
(6)
(5)
EXAMPLE
(4)
(1)
75RM061
(6) Bluetooth® setup button (on steering
wheel)
(7) OFF HOOK button
(8) ON HOOK button
(9) MUTE switch
(10) “VOL” switch
(2)
(3)
66RH078
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
“VOL PUSH PWR” knob
PRESET buttons
BACK button
Bluetooth® setup button (on control panel)
5-48
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Phone registration
To use the hands-free function with this
unit, it is required to register the phone
in advance.
NOTE:
• Up to 5 phones can be registered.
• To set up a new phone, disconnect the
audio player from the unit. Connect the
audio player again after phone setup is
completed if necessary.
• When attempts to establish the pairing
fail within 60 seconds, the connecting
operation will be canceled. Try to establish the pairing again or refer to the manual of the phone in use for how to
establish the pairing with the phone.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Pairing”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Select “CAR AUDIO” from the Bluetooth® menu of the phone and establish
the pairing.
Refer to the manual of the phone in use
for further information.
5) Enter the passkey displayed on the unit
to the phone.
6) When the pairing with the phone is
established, automatic transfer of the
phonebook and the call history
becomes selectable. The automatic
transfer starts with “Yes” and it does not
with “No”.
7) Press ON HOOK button (8).
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• When registering an additional phone,
repeat Step from 1).
Receiving a call
Press OFF HOOK button (7) to receive a
call.
Ending a call
Press ON HOOK button (8) to end a call.
Adjusting the listening volume
• Turn “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (2) during
a call.
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;
turning
it
counterclockwise
decreases the volume.
• Press “VOL” switch (10) during a call.
Pressing the switch up increases the volume; pressing the switch down
decreases the volume.
Adjusting the ring volume
• Turn “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (2) while a
call is coming in.
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;
turning
it
counterclockwise
decreases the volume.
• Press “VOL” switch (10) during a call.
Pressing the switch up increases the volume; pressing the switch down
decreases the volume.
Rejecting a call (only for supported
models)
Press ON HOOK button (8) to reject a
incoming call.
Mute of hands-free microphone
Press MUTE switch (9) to mute the microphone. To cancel the mute, press MUTE
switch (9) again.
5-49
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Adjusting the call or ringtone volume
Follow the instructions below to adjust the
call or ringtone volume.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Sound Setting”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Call Volume” or “Ringtone
Volume”, and press the knob (1) to
determine the selection.
The current call or ringtone volume will
be displayed.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the desired call or ringtone
volume, and press the knob (1) to
determine the selection.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
Dialing using missed/incoming/
outgoing calls
Follow the instructions below to dial to the
previously dialed number again.
NOTE:
Up to 30 phone numbers of the latest calls
can be stored (30 calls including missed,
received and dialed call).
1) Press OFF HOOK button (7).
The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will
be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “All Calls”, “Missed Calls”,
“Incoming Calls” or “Outgoing Calls”,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
To dial from the dialed history or the
received history, select “All Calls”,
“Missed Calls”, “Incoming Calls” or
“Outgoing Calls” respectively.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the desired number, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Dial”, and press the knob
(1) or OFF HOOK button (7) to dial to
the selected number.
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• Pressing “Confirm” after selecting “Add
Speed Dial” can register the selected
number in the speed dial.
• Pressing “Confirm” after selecting
“Delete” can delete the selected number
from the call history.
Deletion of call history
Follow the instructions below to delete a
missed/incoming/outgoing call history.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete History”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Missed Calls”, “Incoming
Calls”, or “Outgoing Calls”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select a number to be deleted or
“ALL”, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection.
5-50
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
7) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete?” or “Delete All?”,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
8) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to complete the deletion.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
Registration in Phonebook
Follow the instructions below to register
phone numbers in the Phonebook of the
unit.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Add Contacts”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Overwrite All” or “Add One
Contact”, and press the knob (1) to
determine the selection.
“Rewrite All (MAX1000): Ok?” or “Rest
of Memory XXXX: Ok?” will be displayed.
6) Press or turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH
SOUND” knob (1) to select “Confirm”,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
7) Transfer contacts from the phone.
When the registration is completed, the
“Setup Phonebook” will be displayed.
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• Up to 1000 numbers can be registered in
Phonebook.
Transfer of call history (Call History)
Follow the instructions below to transfer
call history of the registered phone.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Call History”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Overwrite Call History?”,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to transfer the call history from
the phone.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-51
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Automatic transfer of phonebook/call
history
You can select whether or not the device
transfers the phonebook and the call history automatically when the phone is registered.
Follow the instructions below to select.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “A.Transfer”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Pressing “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (1) switches between “A.transfer
On” and “A.transfer Off”.
5) Selecting “Go Back” or pressing the
BACK button (4) stores displayed setting and the previous menu is displayed.
Making a call by phonebook
Follow the instructions below to dial a number registered in phonebook.
1) Press OFF HOOK button (7).
The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will
be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Phonebook”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the initial of the name you
would like to make a call, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
The registered numbers will be displayed in sequence. If names have
been registered together with numbers,
the names will be displayed.
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the name you would like to
make a call, and press the knob (1) to
determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Dial”, and press the knob
(1) or OFF HOOK button (7).
The displayed number or the number
registered with the displayed name will
be dialed.
Deletion of registered data (Delete
Entry)
Follow the instructions below to delete a
number registered in phonebook.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete Contacts”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the initial of the name you
would like to delete or “ALL”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the name you would like to
delete, and press the knob (1) to determine the selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete?” or “Delete All?”,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
7) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to complete the deletion.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-52
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Registration in speed dial
Follow the instructions below to assign a
number to one of PRESET buttons (3) to
use as the speed dial.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Telephone”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Phonebook”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Add Speed Dial”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the initial of the name you
would like to register in speed dial, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
The registered numbers will be displayed in sequence. If names have
been registered together with numbers,
the names will be displayed.
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select the name you would like to
register in speed dial, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Choose Preset”, and
press one of PRESET buttons (3) to
which the selected number is to be
assigned. If a number is already
assigned to the selected button, a confirmation message will be displayed.
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select a confirmation message,
and press the knob (1) to complete the
assignment.
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to complete the assignment.
When the assignment is completed, the
“Setup Phonebook” will be displayed.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
One-touch call (Speed dial)
Follow the instructions below to dial the
number assigned to each of the PRESET
buttons (3).
1) Press OFF HOOK button (7).
The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will
be displayed.
Pressing one of PRESET buttons (3)
can skip step 2) and the 1st line of step
3).
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Speed Dials”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
3) Press one of PRESET buttons (3).
The assigned number will be displayed.
If no number is assigned, “No Entry” is
displayed.
4) Press OFF HOOK button (7).
The selected number will be dialed.
5-53
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Deletion of speed dial (Del Speed Dial)
Follow the instructions below to delete the
number assigned for the speed dial.
1) Press OFF HOOK button (7).
The Bluetooth® phonebook menu will
be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Speed Dials”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
3) Press one of PRESET buttons (3) to
which the number to be deleted is
assigned.
If the number is not registered, “No
Entry” is displayed.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Del Speed Dial”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to complete the deletion.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
Display of device data (Device Name)
Follow the instructions below to display the
BD (Bluetooth® Device) address and
device name.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Bluetooth Info”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Device Name” or “Device
Address”, and press the knob (1) to display the device name or the BD (Bluetooth® Device) address.
Reset to the factory defaults
Follow the instructions below to reset all
the settings to the factory defaults.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Initialize”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “All Initialize”, and press
the knob (1) to determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to start the reset.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-54
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selection of phone (Select Phone)
Follow the instructions below to select a
phone to be paired with from the registered
phones.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “List Phone”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select a phone to be paired with,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Select”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
List of phones (List Phones)
Follow the instructions below to display the
names of the registered phones in
sequence.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “List Phone”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
The names of the registered phones
are displayed in sequence.
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• The Bluetooth® ready audio device will
be disconnected when the phone is
selected.
Passkey setting (Set Passkey)
Follow the instructions below to set the
security number (passkey).
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Passkey”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Enter New Passkey”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Press or turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH
SOUND” knob (1) to select “Confirm”.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select a number for the first digit,
and press the knob (1) to determine the
selection. Select and determine numbers for the second, third and fourth
digits in order in the same manner.
When not entering up to the eighth
digit, enter blanks for the successive
digits.
7) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (1) to determine the passkey setting.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-55
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Deletion of phone information (Delete
Phone)
Follow the instructions below to delete the
registered phone information.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “List Phone”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select a phone to be deleted, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Delete?”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
7) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
BT function on/off (BT Power)
Follow the instructions below to turn on/off
the Bluetooth® function.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (5)
or (6).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (1) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(1) to select “BT Power”, and press the
knob (1) to determine the selection.
4) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (1) to select “BT Power On” or “BT
Power Off”.
NOTE:
• When the BT function is turned off, the
connection between this unit and the
registered phone in use will be disconnected.
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (4), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-56
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Bluetooth® audio (if equipped)
Steering switch
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(8)
(3)
(4)
(7)
(1)
75RM062
Display
(2)
(A)
(B)
(5)
(6)
66RH079
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
“MEDIA” button
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
UP button
DOWN button
“DISP” button
BACK button
Bluetooth® setup button (on control
panel)
(8) Bluetooth® setup button (on steering
wheel)
(A) Track number
(B) Play time
5-57
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Registration of audio devices
To use Bluetooth® ready audio devices
with this unit, it is required to register the
devices.
NOTE:
• To set up a new audio player, disconnect
the phone from the unit. Connect the
phone after audio player setup is completed if necessary.
• When attempts to establish the pairing
fail within 60 seconds, the connecting
operation will be canceled. Try to establish the pairing again or refer to the audio
player manual for assistance with the
pairing process.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7)
or (8).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Pairing”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
4) Select “CAR AUDIO” from the Bluetooth® menu of the audio player and
establish the pairing.
Refer to the manual of the audio player
in use for further information.
5) Enter the passkey displayed on the unit
to the audio player.
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (6), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• When registering additional audio
devices, repeat Step from 1).
Bluetooth®
Selecting
audio mode
Press “MEDIA” button (1).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
USB (iPod®) (if equipped)
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• Hold down UP button (3) to fast forward
the track.
• Hold down DOWN button (4) to fast
rewind the track.
NOTE:
Some functions may not be available
depending on Bluetooth® audio.
Display change
Press “DISP” button (5).
Each time the button is pressed, display
will change as follows:
Bluetooth® audio (if equipped)
AUX (if equipped)
Play time
Track name
Selecting a group (only for supported
models)
Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob (2)
to select a group.
Selecting a track
• Press UP button (3) to listen to the next
track.
• Press DOWN button (4) twice to listen to
the previous track.
When DOWN button (4) is pressed
once, the track currently being played
will start from the beginning again.
Artist name
Album name
NOTE:
If text data contains more than 16 characters, “>” mark will appear at the right end.
Holding down “DISP” button (5) for 1 second or longer can display the next page.
5-58
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Selection of audio device (Select Audio)
Follow the instructions below to select an
audio device to be paired with from the
registered audio devices.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7)
or (8).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “List Audio”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select an audio device to be
used, and press the knob (2) to determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Select”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
List of audio devices (List Audio)
Follow the instructions below to display the
names of the registered audio devices in
sequence.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7)
or (8).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “List Audio”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
The names of registered audio devices
will be displayed in sequence.
NOTE:
• When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (6), the previous menu will
be displayed.
• The phone will be disconnected when
the Bluetooth® ready audio device is
selected.
Passkey setting (Set Passkey)
Follow the instructions below to set the
security number (Passkey).
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7)
or (8).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (6), the previous menu will
be displayed.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Passkey”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Enter New Passkey”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
5) Press or turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH
SOUND” knob (2) to select “Confirm”.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select a number for the first digit,
and press the knob (2) to determine the
selection. Select and determine numbers for the second, third and fourth
digits in order in the same manner.
When not entering up to the eighth
digit, enter blanks for the successive
digits.
7) Press “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND”
knob (2) to determine the passkey setting.
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (6), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-59
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Deletion of audio device information
(Delete Audio)
Follow the instructions below to delete the
registered audio device information.
1) Press the Bluetooth® setup button (7)
or (8).
The Bluetooth® setup menu will be displayed.
2) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Setup Bluetooth”, and
press the knob (2) to determine the
selection.
3) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “List Audio”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
4) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select an audio device to be
deleted, and press the knob (2) to
determine the selection.
5) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Delete”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
6) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Delete?”, and press the
knob (2) to determine the selection.
7) Turn “TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
(2) to select “Confirm”, and press the
knob (2) to complete the deletion.
Disclaimer for Bluetooth® function
• Depending on compatibility of mobile
phone models, no Bluetooth® function
can be used, or some Bluetooth® functions may be restricted.
• Connectivity or voice quality may get
affected depending on circumstances.
• After the ignition switch is turned to “ON”
position or the engine switch is pressed
to change the ignition mode to ON, the
audio system takes few seconds to
detect and connect to the Bluetooth®
device (if already paired).
Remote audio controls (if equipped)
Controlling basic functions of the audio
system is available using the switches on
the steering wheel.
(1) (3) (4)
(4)
(2)
EXAMPLE
75RM063
NOTE:
When selecting “Go Back” or pressing
BACK button (6), the previous menu will
be displayed.
5-60
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Adjusting the volume
• To increase the volume, press the “VOL”
switch (1) up. The volume will continue
to increase until the switch is released.
• To decrease the volume, press the
“VOL” switch (1) down. The volume will
continue to decrease until the switch is
released.
• To mute the sound, press the switch (2).
Selecting the mode
Press the switch (3).
Each time the button is pressed, the mode
will change as follows:
FM1 (Radio)
FM2 (Radio)
CD
Bluetooth® audio (if equipped)
AUX (if equipped)
USB (iPod®) (if equipped)
AM (Radio)
It is possible to turn on the audio system
by pressing the switch (3).
Selecting the radio station (AM, FM1,
FM2 mode)
• To select the next preset station, press
“>” of the switch (4) only for a moment.
• To select the previous preset station,
press “<” of the switch (4) only for a
moment.
• To scan a higher frequency radio station,
press “>” of the switch (4) for 1 second
or longer.
• To scan a lower frequency radio station,
press “<” of the switch (4) for 1 second
or longer.
Selecting the track (CD, USB (iPod®),
Bluetooth® audio mode)
• To skip to the next track, press “>” of the
switch (4) only for a moment.
• To skip to the previous track, press “<” of
the switch (4) twice only for a moment.
When the switch (4) is pushed down
once only for a moment, the track currently being played will start from the
beginning again.
Fast forwarding/rewinding a track
• To fast forward a track, press “>” of the
switch (4) for 1 second or longer.
• To fast rewind a track, press “<” of the
switch (4) for 1 second or longer.
5-61
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Anti-theft feature
The anti-theft function is intended to discourage thefts. For example, when the
audio system is installed in another vehicle, it will become unable to operate.
This function works by entering a Personal
Identification Number (PIN).
When the unit is disconnected from its
power source, such as when the audio
system is removed or the battery is disconnected, the unit will become inoperable
until the PIN is reentered.
EXAMPLE
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
66RH080
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
VOL PUSH PWR” knob
PRESET buttons ([1] to [6])
UP button
“TUNE/FLD PUSH SOUND” knob
5-62
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Setting the anti-theft function
1) Press “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1) to
power off.
2) Hold down the buttons numbered [1]
and [6] of PRESET buttons (2) and
press “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1).
“SECURITY” will be displayed.
3) Press UP button (3) and the button
numbered [1] of PRESET buttons (2)
simultaneously.
4) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered
as PIN using the buttons numbered [1]
- [4] of PRESET buttons (2).
5) Hold
down
“TUNE/FLD
PUSH
SOUND” knob (4) for 1 second or longer to set the anti-theft function.
NOTE:
Take a note of the registered PIN and keep
it for the future use.
Canceling the anti-theft feature
To cancel the anti-theft function, delete the
registered PIN.
1) Press “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1) to
power off.
2) Hold down the buttons numbered [1]
and [6] of PRESET buttons (2) and
press “VOL PUSH PWR” knob (1).
“PIN ENTRY” will be displayed.
3) Press UP button (3) and the button
numbered [1] of PRESET buttons (2)
simultaneously.
4) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered
as PIN using the buttons numbered [1]
- [4] of PRESET buttons (2).
5) Hold
down
“TUNE/FLD
PUSH
SOUND” knob (4) for 1 second or longer to delete the registered PIN. The
indication “----” will be displayed and
the anti-theft function will be canceled.
NOTE:
To change your PIN, first delete your current PIN, and then set a new one.
Confirming the Personal Identification
Number (PIN)
When the main power source is disconnected such as when the battery is
replaced, etc, it is required to enter the PIN
to operate the unit again.
1) Set the ignition switch to “ACC” position or the ignition mode to ON.
“SECURITY” will be displayed.
2) Press UP button (3) and the button
numbered [1] of PRESET buttons (2)
simultaneously.
3) Enter a 4-digit number to be registered
as PIN using the buttons numbered [1]
- [4] of PRESET buttons (2).
4) Hold
down
“TUNE/FLD
PUSH
SOUND” knob (4) for 1 second or longer.
When the same PIN as registered is
entered, the power of the audio system
will be turned off automatically and it
will become operable again.
NOTE:
If an incorrect PIN is entered, “ERROR”
and the total number of incorrect entry
attempts will be displayed.
If an incorrect PIN is entered 10 times or
more, “HELP” will be displayed and the
audio system will become inoperable.
5-63
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Battery installation
Install a lithium battery (CR2025) with the poles facing the correct direction.
WARNING
• Do not expose the battery to flame.
Do not short circuit, disassemble,
or heat the battery.
• Do not charge the battery.
• Use the specified type battery.
• Keep the button-shaped battery
away from children to prevent accidental swallowing.
If the battery is swallowed, contact a
doctor immediately.
CAUTION
EXAMPLE
Battery replacement timing
• When battery power is depleted, the button may not be operable. If the remote controller
does not operate, replace the battery and check the operation.
Caution on battery
• Be sure to follow the instructions to prevent battery leakage, over-heating, ignition or
explosion.
• Install the battery with the poles
facing the correct direction.
• When not in use for a long period
of time, or if the battery is dead,
remove the battery from the remote
controller.
If battery leakage has occurred, wipe the
container first then install a new battery. If
the battery solution contacts the skin, wash
off with water completely.
5-64
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Caution on remote controller
• Do not leave the remote controller in an
area exposed to direct sunlight, such as
on the dashboard or steering wheel. The
remote controller may deform because
of the heat, (Be especially careful of the
dashboard exposed to direct sunlight in
the summer, as it will become extremely
hot).
• When the vehicle is parked in an area
exposed to direct sunlight, Ensure the
remote controller is placed in an area not
exposed to direct sunlight. For example:
Glove box.
Under direct sunlight, signal reception
from the remote controller weakens. If
this happens, hold the remote controller
close to the signal receptor on the front
panel.
5-65
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Remote controller (if equipped)
Common operations
POWER button
Power ON / OFF
VOLUME button
Press to adjust volume.
(including at AUX mode)
TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button
In Sound Mode
Press to adjust the sound (bass/treble/balance/fader).
In Preset-EQ Mode
The Preset-EQ setting switches as follows:
OFF (FLAT)
JAZZ
ROCK
POP
CLASSIC
HIP-HOP
SEEK
TRACK
MODE button
The mode switches as
follows:
FM1
OFF
LEVEL 1
TUNE/FLD
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
Press to mute the sound. Press it again to cancel
the mute.
TUNE/FLD
1 MENU
2
3
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
MODE
AS
SOUND
SOUND button
While playback, the sound mode switches as
follows (including at AUX mode, except while
displaying iPod® menu):
FM2
In AVC Mode
The AVC setting switches
as follows:
MUTE button
VOL -
CD
Preset-EQ
Bluetooth® audio
(if equipped)
BASS
AUX (if equipped)
TREBLE
(iPod®)
LEVEL 2
USB
(if equipped)
LEVEL 3
AM
BALANCE
FADER
AVC
5-66
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Radio operations
AS button
Press to return to the last received frequency in the previous auto store mode.
Press it for 2 seconds or longer. It selects
the stations with the stronger signals and
stores them in order.
VOL -
SEEK
TRACK
TUNE/FLD
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button
Press to select the radio station.
TUNE/FLD
1 MENU
2
3
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
MODE
AS
SOUND
PRESET buttons (1-6)
Press to select the desired preset station.
NOTE:
When there are fewer than 6 stations that can be stored even if 1 round of auto store operation is performed, no station will be
stored at the remaining preset buttons.
5-67
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
CD operations
SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button
Press to skip to the next/previous track.
Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/
fast-rewind the track.
RDM (5) button
Press to play the current track randomly.
Press it again to cancel.
VOL -
SEEK
TRACK
TUNE/FLD
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
TUNE/FLD
RPT (4) button
Press to plays the current track repeatedly.
Press it again to cancel.
DISP (6) button
The display switches as follows:
1 MENU
2
3
Play time
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
Disc title
MODE
AS
SOUND
Track title
Press it for 1 second or longer to display the
next page.
5-68
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
MP3/WMA/AAC Disc operations
SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button
Press to skip to the next/previous track.
Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the track.
TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button
Press to skip to the next/previous folder.
DISP (6) button
The display switches as follows:
RPT (4) button
The repeat mode switches as follows:
OFF
VOL -
SEEK
TRACK
RDM (5) button
The random mode switches as follows:
OFF
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
Play time
Folder name
File name
FILE REPEAT
FOLDER REPEAT
TUNE/FLD
TUNE/FLD
1 MENU
2
3
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
MODE
AS
Album name (MP3, AAC only)
Track title
SOUND
Artist name
Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next
page.
FOLDER RANDOM
ALL RANDOM
5-69
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
USB operations
SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button
Press to skip to the next/previous file.
Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the file.
TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button
Press to skip to the next/previous folder.
DISP (6) button
The display switches as follows:
RPT (4) button
The repeat mode switches as follows:
OFF
VOL -
SEEK
TRACK
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
Play time
Folder name
File name
FILE REPEAT
FOLDER REPEAT
TUNE/FLD
TUNE/FLD
1 MENU
2
3
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
MODE
AS
Album name (MP3, AAC only)
Track title
SOUND
Artist name
RDM (5) button
The random mode switches as follows:
Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next
page.
OFF
FOLDER RANDOM
ALL RANDOM
5-70
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
iPod® operations
SEEK TRACK UP/DOWN button
ENT button
Press to skip to the next/previous file.
Press it for 1 second or longer to fast-forward/fastrewind the file.
While displaying iPod® menu, press to select the
desired item and display the list. When a track is
selected from the list, the playback starts.
DISP (6) button
TUNE FOLDER UP/DOWN button
While displaying iPod® menu, press to display the next/previous list in the same layer.
The display switches as follows:
VOL -
SEEK
TRACK
RPT (4) button
Press to play the current track repeatedly.
Press it again to cancel.
TUNE/FLD
ENT
VOL +
SEEK
TRACK
2
3
4 RPT
5 RDM
6 DISP
AS
Artist name / Track title
Album name / Track title
TUNE/FLD
1 MENU
MODE
Playlist name /
Track title (Playlist mode only)
SOUND
Track title / Play time
Press it for 1 second or longer to display the next
page.
RDM (5) button
The random mode switches as follows:
OFF
SONG RANDOM
MENU button
ALBUM RANDOM
During playback
• Press to display iPod® menu.
• Press it for 1 second or longer to display the top menu.
While iPod® menu is displayed
• Press to display the folder in one layer upper.
• Press it for 1 second or longer to display the top menu.
5-71
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Troubleshooting
When encountering a problem, check and follow the instructions below.
If the described suggestions do not solve the problem, it is recommended to take the unit to your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Problem
Possible cause
Possible solution
Common
Unable to operate
The security function is on.
When “SECURITY” is displayed, enter
the PIN.
When “HELP” is displayed, contact your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Unable to turn on the power
(No sound is produced)
Fuse is blown.
Contact your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
High noise
It may not be exactly tuned in to the station.
Tune it in exactly to the station.
Unable to receive by auto tuning
There may be no station emitting signals
powerful enough.
Pick up a station by manual tuning.
The disc is dirty.
Wipe the disc with a soft cloth.
The disc has a major scratch or is
warped.
Replace the disc with the one which has
no scratch and warp.
Radio
CD
Sound skips or noise produced
5-72
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Problem
Possible cause
Possible solution
MP3/WMA/AAC
No playback
The disc contains unsupported formatted
data.
Check the file format.
Sound skips or noise produced
Sound skipping may occur when playing
VBR (Variable Bit Rate) files.
It is not recommended to play VBR files.
There is no supported format file to play
on this unit.
Check the file format.
The current consumption of the USB
device exceeds 1.0 A.
Use a USB device with a current consumption lower than 1.0 A.
The distance between this unit and the
Bluetooth® ready device is too far, or a
metallic object may be located between
the Bluetooth® ready device and this unit.
Change the location of the Bluetooth®
ready device.
USB
Playback does not start when the USB
device is connected
Bluetooth®
Pairing failed
®
The Bluetooth function of the
ready device is off.
Bluetooth®
Refer to the manual of the Bluetooth®
ready device (Some devices have the
power saving function that automatically
activates after a certain time).
Unable to receive a call
Your current location may be out of service area.
Drive your vehicle to the service area of
the phone.
The voice quality of hands-free is low
(Distortion, noise etc.)
Another wireless device may be located
near the unit.
Switch off the wireless device or keep it
away from the unit.
5-73
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Error display messages
Display
Possible cause
Possible solution
CD
“ERROR 1”
The disc cannot be read.
Insert the disc with its label side up.
Check the disc if it is not warped or is free of flaws.
When “ERROR 1” does not disappear even when a normal disc is inserted, contact your dealer.
“ERROR 3”
The player developed an error of an
unidentified cause.
When the CD is in the unit, press the CD eject button to
remove the disc.
When the disc cannot be ejected, contact your dealer.
The USB device is disconnected.
Check the connection of the USB device.
“ERROR 2”
Impossible to communicate correctly with
the USB device.
Unplug the USB device and plug it again.
Check the USB device.
“ERROR 3”
Inoperable due to an unidentified cause.
Unplug the USB device and plug it again.
When “ERROR 3” does not disappear, contact your
dealer.
“ERROR 4”
The current consumption of the USB
device exceeds 1.0 A.
Check the USB device.
USB/iPod®
“USB ERROR”
5-74
66RH0-74E
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT
Display
Possible cause
Possible solution
The player developed an error of an
unidentified cause.
Disconnect the Bluetooth® ready device and connect it
again.
When “ERROR 1” does not disappear, contact your
dealer.
Failed to establish pairing or connection.
Try to establish the pairing or connection again.
“Memory Full”
Reached the limit for the number of phonebook data in transfer.
Delete registered data of unnecessary number in phonebook and try to transfer the register phone numbers in
the phonebook again.
“Not Available”
Inoperable during driving.
Operate the system after pulling over your car.
Bluetooth®
“ERROR 1”
“Connection Failed”
5-75
66RH0-74E
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Vehicle loading .................................................................... 6-1
Trailer towing ....................................................................... 6-1
6
54G215
66RH0-74E
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING
Vehicle loading
Your vehicle was designed for specific
weight capacities. The weight capacities of
your vehicle are indicated by the Gross
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the
Permissible maximum Axle Weight (PAW,
front and rear). The GVWR and PAW (front
and rear) are listed in the “SPECIFICATIONS” section.
GVWR – Maximum permissible overall
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including
all the occupants, accessories and cargo
plus the trailer nose weight if towing a
trailer).
PAW (front and rear) – Maximum permissible weight on an individual axle.
Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and
actual loads at the front and rear axles can
only be determined by weighing the vehicle. Compare these weights to the GVWR
and PAW (front and rear). If the gross vehicle weight or the load on either axle
exceeds these ratings, you must remove
enough weight to bring the load down to
the rated capacity.
WARNING
Never overload your vehicle. The
gross vehicle weight (sum of the
weights of the vehicle, all the occupants, accessories, cargo plus trailer
nose weight if towing a trailer) must
never exceed the Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating (GVWR). In addition,
never distribute a load so that the
weight on either the front or rear axle
exceeds the Permissible maximum
Axle Weight (PAW).
Trailer towing
Your MARUTI SUZUKI was originally
designed to carry people and a normal
amount of cargo, not to tow a trailer.
WARNING
Always distribute cargo evenly. To
avoid personal injury or damage to
your vehicle, always secure cargo to
prevent it from shifting if the vehicle
moves suddenly. Place heavier
objects on the floor and as far forward in the cargo area as possible.
Never pile cargo higher than the top
of the seat backs.
6-1
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
60G410
Maintenance schedule ........................................................ 7-2
Periodic maintenance schedule ........................................ 7-2
Drive belt .............................................................................. 7-6
Engine oil and filter ............................................................. 7-6
Engine coolant .................................................................... 7-11
Air cleaner ............................................................................ 7-13
Spark plugs (Petrol engine model) .................................... 7-13
Gear oil ................................................................................. 7-14
Clutch pedal ......................................................................... 7-15
Fuel filter (Diesel engine model) ........................................ 7-16
Brakes .................................................................................. 7-16
Steering ................................................................................ 7-18 7
Tires ...................................................................................... 7-18
Battery .................................................................................. 7-21
Fuses .................................................................................... 7-22
Headlight aiming ................................................................. 7-26
Bulb replacement ................................................................ 7-26
Wiper blades ........................................................................ 7-31
Windshield washer fluid ..................................................... 7-34
Air conditioning system ..................................................... 7-34
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
WARNING
EXAMPLE
60B128
WARNING
Take extreme care when working on
your vehicle to prevent accidental
injury. Carefully observe the following precautions:
• To prevent damage or unintended
activation of the air bag system or
seat belt pretensioner system, check
that the battery is disconnected and
the ignition switch has been in
“LOCK” position or the ignition
mode has been LOCK (OFF) for at
least 90 seconds before performing
any electrical service work on your
MARUTI SUZUKI vehicle. Do not
touch air bag system components,
seat belt pretensioner system components or wires.
The wires are wrapped with yellow
tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow for easy identification.
• Do not leave the engine running in
garages or other confined areas.
(Continued)
(Continued)
• When the engine is running, keep
hands, clothing, tools, and other
objects away from the fan and drive
belt. Even though the fan may not
be moving, it can automatically
turn on without warning.
• When it is necessary to perform
service work with the engine running, check that the parking brake
is set fully and the transaxle is in
Neutral (for manual transaxle or
Auto Gear Shift vehicles).
• Do not touch ignition wires or other
ignition system parts when starting
the engine or when the engine is
running, or you could receive an
electric shock.
• Be careful not to touch a hot
engine, exhaust manifold and
pipes, muffler, radiator and water
hoses.
• Do not allow smoking, sparks, or
flames around fuel or the battery.
Flammable fumes are present.
• Do not get under your vehicle if it is
supported only with the portable
jack provided in your vehicle.
• Be careful not to cause accidental
short circuits between the positive
and negative battery terminals.
(Continued)
WARNING
(Continued)
• Keep used oil, coolant, and other
fluids away from children and pets.
Dispose of used fluids properly;
never pour them on the ground,
into sewers, etc.
7-1
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Maintenance Schedule
The following table shows the times when
you should perform regular maintenance
on your vehicle. This table shows in kilometers and months when you should perform inspections, adjustments, lubrication
and other services.
WARNING
MARUTI SUZUKI recommends that
maintenance on your Maruti Suzuki
vehicle should be performed by
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
NOTICE
Whenever it becomes necessary to
replace parts on your vehicle, it is
recommended that you use MARUTI
genuine replacement parts or their
equivalent.
Periodic Maintenance
Schedule
“C”: Clean
“R”: Replace or Change
“I”: Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or
replace as necessary
“L”: Lubricate
“T”: Tighten to Specified Torque
“O”: Rotate
NOTE:
This table includes services as scheduled
up to 80,000 km mileage. Beyond 80,000
km, carry out the same services at the
same intervals respectively.
7-2
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading
or months, whichever comes first.
km (x1000)
months
FREE INSPECTION
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST
1
5
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
1
6
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
ENGINE
1-1.
Water pump drive belt (Tension, Wear)
-
-
-
I
-
I
-
I
-
R
1-2.
Engine coolant (Level, Leakage)
l
l
l
R
l
R
l
R
l
R
R
Petrol
1-3.
Engine oil, engine oil filter and drain plug gasket (Level, Leakage)
I
I
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
1-4.
Cooling system hoses and connections (Leakage and Damage)
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
1-5.
Engine cylinder head bolts
-
-
T
-
T
-
T
-
T
-
1-6.
Petrol
Engine mounting and manifold fixing (Loose Damage)
-
-
I
-
I
-
I
-
I
-
1-7.
Valve clearance
-
-
-
-
I
-
-
I
-
-
1-8.
Exhaust system (Noise, Leakage etc.)
-
l
-
l
-
I
-
I
-
l
1-9.
Positive crank case ventilation system
(Hoses, Connections and Valve)
Petrol
-
l
-
l
-
I
-
I
-
l
1-10.
Exhaust gas recirculation valve
Diesel
-
-
-
-
C
-
-
C
-
-
Petrol
IGNITION
2-1.
Ignition wire (Damage, Deterioration)
Petrol
-
-
-
l
-
l
-
l
-
l
2-2.
Spark plug
Petrol
-
-
-
-
-
R
-
-
-
R
FUEL
Paved-road
3-1.
Air cleaner filter element
Dusty
Condition
Petrol
Clean every 5,000 KM. Replace after every 40,000 KM.
Diesel
Clean every 10,000 KM. Replace after every 40,000 KM.
Petrol
Clean every 2,500 KM or as required. Replace after every 40,000 KM.
Replace more frequently if dust condition is severe.
Diesel
3-2.
Fuel tank cap, fuel lines and connections (Leakage and Damage)
-
l
-
-
-
l
-
-
-
l
3-3.
Fuel filter (Leakage)
Petrol
l
l
l
l
l
R
l
l
l
R
3-4.
Fuel filter and water draining
Diesel
I
I
I
R
I
R
I
R
I
R
CLUTCH AND TRANSMISSION
4-1.
Clutch pedal (Play)
Petrol
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
4-2.
Clutch fluid (Level, Leakage)
Diesel
l
l
l
R
l
R
l
R
l
R
4-3.
Clutch slipping (Dragging or Excess Damage)
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
7-3
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading
or months, whichever comes first.
km (x1000)
months
4-4.
Manual transmission oil (Level, Leakage)
4-5.
Gear shifter (Operation)
FREE INSPECTION
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST
1
5
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
1
6
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
Replace at 1,60,000 km or 10 years whichever comes first.
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
DRIVE SHAFT
5-1.
Drive shaft noise
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
5-2.
Drive shaft boot (Damage)
-
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
l
R
BRAKE
6-1.
Brake fluid (Level, Leakage)
I
I
I
R
I
R
I
R
I
6-2.
Brake pedal (Pedal - carpet clearance)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
6-3.
Parking brake lever and cable (Play, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
6-4.
Brake disc and pad (Wear)
-
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
6-5.
Brake drum and shoes (Wear)
-
-
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
6-6.
Master cylinder, wheel cylinder, caliper piston
(Fluid leakage, Boot/Seal damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
6-7.
Brake hoses and pipes (Fluid leakage, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
7-1.
Tyres (Air pressure, Abnormal wear, Crack and Rotation)
I
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
I&O
7-2.
Wheels (Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
7-3.
Front/Rear wheel bearing (Loose, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
WHEEL
FRONT / REAR SUSPENSION
8-1.
Suspension strut (Oil leakage, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-2.
Suspension arms / Knuckle support and Torsion rods (Loose, Damage)
-
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-3.
Rear spring (Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-4.
Shock absorbers (Oil leakage, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
8-5.
All bolts and nuts (Loose)
-
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
7-4
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer reading
or months, whichever comes first.
km (x1000)
months
FREE INSPECTION
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE AT COST
1
5
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
1
6
12
24
36
48
60
72
84
96
STEERING
9-1.
Steering wheel (Play, Loose)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
9-2.
All rods and arms (Loose, Damage, Wear)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
9-3.
Tilt steering (Operation)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
ELECTRICAL
10-1.
Battery - Electrolyte (Level, Leakage) and voltage
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10-2.
Wiring harness connection (Loose, Damage)
-
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10-3.
Lighting system (Operation, Stains, Damage)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10-4.
Wiper (Operation)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10-5.
Horn (Operation)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
10-6.
AUX, USB and accessory socket (Operation)
-
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
11-1.
All chassis bolts and nuts (Tighten)
-
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
11-2.
All latches, hinges and locks (Function)
I
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
I&L
BODY
ROAD TEST
12-1.
Operation of Brakes, gear shifting and speedometer
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
12-2.
Body and chassis noise
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
AIR CONDITIONER
13-1.
Check belt tension
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
13-2.
Tighten compressor mounting bolt
-
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
I
13-3.
All hose joint (Check, Tighten)
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
13-4.
Check functioning of recirculating flap
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
13-5.
Clean condenser with low pressure water
-
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
C
13-6.
Check belt for frayed edges
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
13-7.
Check all mounting bolts
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
13-8.
Air conditioner filter element (if equipped)
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
R
I
I
7-5
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Drive belt
Engine oil and filter
(For petrol engine model)
(2)
WARNING
The belts should also be examined to
ensure that they are not damaged.
If you need to replace or adjust the belt
have it done by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
(For petrol engine model)
(4)
When the engine is running, keep
hands, hair, clothing, tools, etc. away
from the moving fan and drive belts.
Check that the drive belt tension is correct.
If the belt is too loose, insufficient battery
charging, engine overheating, poor power
steering, poor air conditioning, or excessive belt wear can result. When you press
the belt with your thumb midway between
the pulleys, there should be a deflection
according to the following chart.
Specified oil
(1)
EXAMPLE
(a)
(3) (6)
(5)
(1)
EXAMPLE
75RM359
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Front
Rear
Generator
Water pump
Air conditioner compressor
Tensioner pulley
Drive belt deflection
(100 N (10 kg, 22 lbs) press)
(a) 5.2 – 6.0 mm (0.20 – 0.24 in.)
(For diesel engine model)
The drive belts tension is adjusted automatically.
71LST0701
(1) Preferred
Be sure that the engine oil you use comes
under the quality classification of SL, SM
or SN. Select the appropriate oil viscosity
according to the above chart.
SAE 0W-20 (1) is the best choice for good
fuel economy and good starting in cold
weather.
7-6
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Oil level check
(For diesel engine model)
EXAMPLE
(For diesel engine model)
(For petrol engine model)
EXAMPLE
(1)
5W-30, 5W-40
o
C -30
F -22
o
-20
-4
-10
14
0
32
10
50
20
68
30
86
40
104
EXAMPLE
79MH0760
66RM07001
(1) Preferred
Be sure that the engine oil you use comes
under the quality classification of ACEA
A5/B5. Select the appropriate oil viscosity
according to the above chart.
68PH00702
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
Upper
Lower
SAE 5W-30 (1) is the best choice for good
fuel economy, and good starting in cold
weather.
(3)
(2)
(1)
54P000701
52D084
(1) MIN
(2) MAX
(3) Engine oil dipstick
7-7
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
It is important to keep the engine oil at the
correct level for proper lubrication of your
vehicle’s engine. Check the oil level with
the vehicle on a level surface. The oil level
indication may be inaccurate if the vehicle
is on a slope. The oil level should be
checked either before starting the engine
or at least 5 minutes after stopping the
engine.
The handle of the engine oil dipstick is colored with yellow for easy identification.
Pull out the oil dipstick, wipe oil off with a
clean cloth, insert the dipstick all the way
into the engine, and then remove it again.
The oil on the stick should be between the
upper and lower limits shown on the stick.
If the oil level indication is near the lower
limit, add enough oil to raise the level to
the upper limit.
Refilling
not to overfill the oil. Too much oil is almost
as bad as too little oil. After refilling, start the
engine and allow it to idle for about a minute. Stop the engine, wait about 5 minutes
and check the oil level again.
(For petrol engine model)
EXAMPLE
Changing engine oil and filter
Open
Close
Drain the engine oil while the engine is still
warm.
EXAMPLE
Close
Open
68PH00762
(For diesel engine model)
EXAMPLE
NOTICE
Failure to check the oil level regularly
could lead to serious engine trouble
due to insufficient oil.
Open
Close
NOTICE
(For diesel engine model)
Do not top up the oil over the MAX
limit. Too much oil causes serious
engine trouble.
66RH001
1) Remove the oil filler cap.
2) Place a drain pan under the drain plug.
3) Using a wrench, remove the drain plug
and drain the engine oil.
CAUTION
82PM07001
Remove the oil filler cap and pour oil slowly
through the filler hole to bring the oil level
to the upper limit on the dipstick. Be careful
The engine oil temperature may be
high enough to burn your fingers
when the drain plug is loosened. Wait
until the drain plug is cool enough to
touch with your bare hands.
7-8
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
WARNING
EXAMPLE
(For petrol engine model)
EXAMPLE
(Continued)
To minimize your exposure to used
oil, wear a long-sleeve shirt and
moisture-proof gloves (such as dishwashing gloves) when changing oil. If
oil contacts your skin, wash thoroughly with soap and water.
Launder any clothing or rags if it is
with oil.
Recycle or properly dispose of used
oil and oil filters.
68PH00705
Tightening torque for drain plug
Petrol engine :
35 Nm (3.6 kg-m, 25.8 lb-ft)
Diesel engine :
20 Nm (2.0 kg-m, 14.8 lb-ft)
WARNING
Engine oil can be hazardous. Children and pets may be harmed by
swallowing new or used oil. Keep
new and used oil and used oil filters
away from children and pets.
Repeated, prolonged contact with
used engine oil may cause skin cancer.
Brief contact with used oil may irritate skin.
(Continued)
4) Reinstall the drain plug with new gasket. Tighten the plug with a wrench to
the specified torque.
Oil filter replacement
NOTE:
(For diesel engine model)
Since special procedures and tools are
required, ask your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop for this job.
1) Using an oil filter wrench, turn the oil filter counterclockwise and remove it.
2) Using a clean rag, wipe off the mounting surface on the engine where the
new filter will be seated.
3) Smear a small amount of engine oil
around the rubber gasket of the new oil
filter.
4) Screw the new filter by hand until the filter gasket contacts the mounting surface.
(1)
(2)
68PH00706
(1) Loosen
(2) Tighten
Tightening (viewed from filter top)
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
54G093
(1) Oil filter
(2) 3/4 turn
7-9
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
(For diesel engine model)
NOTICE
To prevent oil leakage, check that the
oil filter is tight, but do not overtighten it.
(2)
(1)
EXAMPLE
84E016
(1) Loosen
(2) Tighten
NOTICE
To tighten the oil filter properly, it is
important to accurately identify the
position at which the filter gasket
first contacts the mounting surface.
5) Tighten the filter as specified below
from the point of contact with the
mounting surface (or to the specified
torque) using an oil filter wrench.
Tightening torque for oil filter
Petrol engine :
3/4 turn or
14 Nm (1.4 kg-m, 10.3 lb-ft)
Diesel engine :
25 Nm (2.5 kg-m, 18.5 lb-ft)
Refill with oil and oil leakage check
1) Pour oil through the filler hole and
install the filler cap.
For the approximate capacity of the oil,
refer to “Capacities” in the “SPECIFICATIONS” section.
2) Start the engine and carefully check the
oil filter and the drain plug for leakage.
Run the engine at various speeds for at
least 5 minutes.
3) Stop the engine and wait about 5 minutes. Check the oil level again and add
oil if necessary. Check for leakage
again.
NOTICE
• When replacing the oil filter, it is
recommended that you use a
MARUTI genuine replacement filter.
If you use an aftermarket filter,
check that it is of equivalent quality
and follow the manufacturer’s
instructions.
• Oil leakage from the periphery of
the oil filter or drain plug indicate
incorrect installation or gasket
damage. If you find any leakage or
are not sure that the filter has been
properly tightened, have the vehicle inspected by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
7-10
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Engine coolant
Selection of coolant
To maintain optimum performance and
durability of your engine, use MARUTI
genuine coolant or equivalent.
This type of coolant is the best for cooling
system for the following reasons:
• The coolant helps maintain proper
engine temperature.
• It gives proper protection against freezing and boiling.
• It gives proper protection against corrosion and rust.
Failure to use the proper coolant can damage your cooling system. Your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop can help you
select the proper coolant.
NOTICE
To avoid damaging your cooling system:
• Always use a high quality ethylene
glycol base non-silicate type coolant diluted with distilled water at
the correct mixture concentration.
• Make sure that the proper mix is 50/
50 coolant to distilled water (Diesel) and 30/70 (Petrol) and in no
case higher than 70/30. Concentrations greater than 70/30 coolant to
distilled water will cause overheating conditions.
• Do not use straight coolant nor
plain water.
• Do not add extra inhibitors or additives. They may not be compatible
with your cooling system.
• Do not mix different types of base
coolants. Doing so may result in
accelerated seal wear and/or the
possibility of severe overheating
and extensive engine damage.
Coolant level check
Check the coolant level at the reservoir
tank, not at the radiator. With the engine
cool, the coolant level should be between
“FULL” and “LOW” marks.
Adding coolant
WARNING
Swallowing engine coolant can cause
severe injury or death. Inhaling coolant mist or vapors or getting coolant
in your eyes could result in severe
injury.
• Do not drink antifreeze or coolant
solution. If swallowed, do not
induce vomiting. Immediately contact a poison control center or a
physician.
• Avoid inhaling coolant mist or hot
vapors. If inhaled, remove to a
fresh air area.
• If coolant gets in the eyes, flush
with water and seek medical attention.
• Wash thoroughly after handling
coolant.
• Keep engine coolant out of the
reach of children and pets.
7-11
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTICE
NOTICE
• The mixture you use should contain 50% concentration of antifreeze.
• If the lowest ambient temperature
in your area is expected to be –35°C
(–31°F) or below, use higher concentrations up to 60% following the
instructions on the antifreeze container.
When putting the cap on the reservoir tank, line up the mark on the cap
and the mark on the tank. Failure to
follow this can result in coolant leakage.
If the coolant level is below “LOW” mark,
more coolant should be added. When the
engine is cool, remove the degassing tank
cap by turning it counterclockwise slowly to
release any pressure. And add coolant
until the degassing tank level reaches
“FULL” mark. Never fill the degassing tank
above “FULL” mark.
Coolant replacement
(For diesel engine model)
Since special procedures are required, ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
for this job.
EXAMPLE
(For petrol engine model)
FULL
LOW
FULL
66RH089
EXAMPLE
LOW
81PN200
If the coolant level is below “LOW” mark,
more coolant should be added. Remove
the reservoir tank cap and add coolant until
the reservoir tank level reaches “FULL”
mark. Never fill the reservoir tank above
“FULL” mark.
WARNING
It is hazardous to remove the reservoir tank cap (degassing tank cap) for
a diesel engine when the water temperature is high, because scalding
fluid and steam may be blown out
under pressure. Wait until the coolant
temperature has lowered before
removing the cap.
7-12
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Air cleaner
(For diesel engine model)
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there
will be greater intake resistance, resulting
in decreased power output and increased
fuel consumption.
EXAMPLE
Spark plugs
(Petrol engine model)
Spark plug replacement and inspection
Since special procedures, materials and
tools are required, it is recommended that
you trust this job to your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
(For petrol engine model)
EXAMPLE
66RH090
75RM064
1) Unclamp the side clamps and remove
the element from the air cleaner case. If
it appears to be dirty, replace it with a
new one.
2) Clamp the side clamps securely.
7-13
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Gear oil
Gear oil level check
Manual transaxle oil /
Auto Gear Shift oil
(For petrol engine model)
EXAMPLE
When adding gear oil, use gear oil with the
appropriate viscosity and grade as shown
in the chart below.
(1)
We highly recommend you use “MARUTI
GENUINE GEAR OIL 75W-80” for manual
transaxle or Auto Gear Shift oil.
Manual transaxle oil /
Auto Gear Shift oil
EXAMPLE
68KH073
75W-80
o
C -30
o
F -22
-20
-4
-10
14
0
32
10
50
(1) Oil filler and level plug
20
68
30
86
40
104
(For diesel engine model)
EXAMPLE
68LM728
(2)
(2) Oil filler and level plug
(for Auto Gear Shift)
(3) Oil filler and level plug
(for manual transaxle)
To check the gear oil level, use the following procedure:
1) Park the vehicle on a level surface with
the parking brake applied. Then, stop
the engine.
2) Remove the oil filler and level plug.
3) If gear oil flows from the plug hole, the
oil level is correct. Reinstall the plug. If
gear oil does not flow from the plug
hole, add oil through the filler plug hole
until oil flows a little from the plug hole.
Tightening torque for oil filler and level
plug
Manual transaxle (1) or (3):
21 Nm (2.1 kg-m, 15.5 lb-ft)
Auto Gear Shift (1) or (2):
21 Nm (2.1 kg-m, 15.5 lb-ft)
CAUTION
After driving the vehicle, the gear oil
temperature may be high enough to
burn you. Wait until the oil filler and
level plug are cool enough to touch
with your bare hands before inspecting gear oil level.
(3)
68PH00712
7-14
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTICE
When tightening the plug, apply the
following sealing compound or
equivalent to the plug threads to prevent oil leakage.
MARUTI SUZUKI Bond No. “1216E” or
“1217G”.
Clutch pedal
Fluid control clutch (if equipped)
Cable control clutch (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
Gear oil change
MAX
MIN
Since special procedures, materials and
tools are required, ask your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop for this job.
66RH139
54G274
Clutch pedal play “d”:
10 - 15 mm (0.4 - 0.6 in.)
Measure the clutch pedal play by moving
the clutch pedal with your hand and measuring the distance it moves until you feel
slight resistance. The play in the clutch
pedal should be between the specified values. If the play is more or less than the
above, or clutch dragging is felt with the
pedal fully depressed, have the clutch
inspected by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
Check the clutch pedal for smooth operation and clutch fluid level from time to time.
If clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully
depressed, have the clutch inspected by
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If
the clutch fluid level is near “MIN” line, fill it
up to “MAX” line with Maruti Genuine
Brake Fluid (MGBF) or DOT 3.
We highly recommend to use “Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid” (MGBF).
7-15
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Fuel filter
(Diesel engine model)
If the fuel filter warning light comes on
when driving, there is a possibility that
water is in the fuel filter. Drain water as
soon as possible. Have your vehicle
inspected by an authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
Brakes
WARNING
Brake fluid
EXAMPLE
MAX
MIN
66RH139
Check the brake fluid level by looking at
the reservoir in the engine compartment.
Check that the fluid level is between “MAX”
and “MIN” lines. If the brake fluid level is
near “MIN” line, fill it up to “MAX” line with
Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid (MGBF) or
DOT 3.
We highly recommend to use “Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid” (MGBF).
Failure to follow the guidelines below
can result in personal injury or serious damage to the brake system.
• If the brake fluid in the reservoir
drops below a certain level, the
brake warning light on the instrument cluster will come on (the
engine must be running with the
parking brake fully disengaged).
Should the light come on, immediately ask your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop to inspect the
brake system.
• A rapid fluid loss indicates leakage
in the brake system which should
be inspected by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop immediately.
• Do not use any fluid other than
Maruti Genuine Brake Fluid (MGBF)
or DOT 3. Do not use reclaimed
fluid or fluid that has been stored in
old or open containers. It is essential that foreign particles and other
liquids are kept out of the brake
fluid reservoir.
CAUTION
Brake fluid can harm your eyes and
damage painted surfaces. Be careful
when refilling the reservoir.
7-16
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
NOTE:
When measuring the distance between the
brake pedal and floor wall, be sure not to
include the floor mat or rubber on the floor
wall in your measurement.
WARNING
Brake fluid is harmful or fatal if swallowed, and harmful if it comes in contact with skin or eyes. If swallowed,
do not induce vomiting. Immediately
contact a poison control center or a
physician. If brake fluid gets in eyes,
flush eyes with water and seek medical attention. Wash thoroughly after
handling. Solution can be poisonous
to animals. Keep out of reach of children and animals.
NOTE:
With disc brakes, the fluid level can be
expected to gradually fall as the brake
pads wear.
Brake pedal
Check brake pedal stroke. If the stroke is
so large, have the brake system inspected
by your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop. If you doubt the brake pedal is at its
normal height, check it as follows:
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
54G108
Minimum distance between brake pedal
and floor carpet “a”:
Petrol engine model:
52 mm (2.0 in.)
Diesel engine model:
44 mm (1.7 in.)
With the engine running, measure the distance between the brake pedal and floor
carpet when the pedal is depressed with
approximately 30 kg (66 lbs) of force. The
minimum distance required is as specified.
Since your vehicle’s brake system is selfadjusting, there is no need for pedal
adjustment.
If the pedal to floor carpet distance as
measured above is less than the minimum
distance required, have your vehicle
inspected by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
60G104S
WARNING
If you experience any of the following
problems with your vehicle’s brake
system, have the vehicle inspected
immediately by your authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
• Poor braking performance
• Uneven braking (brakes not working uniformly on all wheels).
• Excessive pedal travel
• Brake dragging
• Excessive noise
7-17
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Steering
Parking brake
EXAMPLE
(1)
Tires
EXAMPLE
“c”
“b”
EXAMPLE
68PM7001
Ratchet tooth specification “b”:
4th – 9th
Lever pull force (1):
200 N (20 kg, 45 lbs)
Check the parking brake for proper adjustment by counting the number of clicks
made by the ratchet teeth as you slowly
pull up on the parking brake lever to the
point of full engagement. The parking
brake lever should stop between the specified ratchet teeth and the rear wheels
should be securely locked. If the parking
brake is not properly adjusted or the
brakes drag after the lever has been fully
released, have the parking brake inspected
and/or adjusted by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
75RM035
Steering wheel play “c”:
0 – 30 mm (0.0 – 1.2 in.)
Check the play of the steering wheel by
gently turning it from left to right and right
to left, with wheels in straight ahead position and engine in OFF condition. Measure
the distance that the steering moves
before you feel slight resistance. The play
should be between the specified values.
74LHT0704
The front and rear tire pressure specifications are listed on the tire information label.
Both front and rear tires should have the
specified tire pressure.
Note that the value does not apply to the
compact spare tire, if equipped.
Check that the steering wheel turns easily
and smoothly without rattling by turning it
all the way to the right and to the left while
driving very slowly in an open area. If the
amount of free play is not as specified or
you find anything else to be wrong, an
inspection must be performed by your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
7-18
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Tire inspection
Inspect your vehicle’s tires at least once a
month by performing the following checks:
1) Measure the air pressure with a tire
gauge. Adjust the pressure if necessary. Remember to check the spare
tire, too.
CAUTION
EXAMPLE
Hitting curbs and running over rocks
can damage tires and affect wheel
alignment. Have tires and wheel
alignment checked periodically by
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
(1)
WARNING
• Air pressures should be checked
when the tires are cold or you may
get inaccurate readings.
• Check the inflation pressure from
time to time while inflating the tire
gradually, until the specified pressure is obtained.
• Never under-inflate or over-inflate
the tires.
Under-inflation can cause unusual
handling characteristics or can
cause the rim to slip on the tire
bead, resulting in an accident or
damage to the tire or rim.
Over-inflation can cause the tire to
burst, resulting in personal injury.
Over-inflation can also cause
unusual handling characteristics
which may result in an accident.
4) Check for loose wheel nuts.
5) Check that there are no nails, stones or
other objects sticking into the tires.
(2)
52KM110
(1) Tread wear indicator
(2) Indicator location mark
2) Check that the depth of the tread
groove is more than 1.6 mm (0.06 in.).
To help you check this, the tires have
molded-in tread wear indicators in the
grooves. When the indicators appear
on the tread surface, the remaining
depth of the tread is 1.6 mm (0.06 in.).
or less and the tire should be replaced.
3) Check for abnormal wear, cracks and
damage. Any tires with cracks or other
damage should be replaced. If any tires
show abnormal wear, have them
inspected by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
7-19
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
WARNING
• Your MARUTI SUZUKI vehicle is
equipped with tires which are all
the same type and size. This is
important to ensure proper steering
and handling of the vehicle. Never
mix tires of different size or type on
the four wheels of your vehicle. The
size and type of tires used should
be only those approved by MARUTI
SUZUKI as standard or optional
equipment for your vehicle.
• Replacing the wheels and tires
equipped on your vehicle with certain combinations of aftermarket
wheels and tires can significantly
change the steering and handling
characteristics of your vehicle.
• Therefore, use only those wheel
and tire combinations approved by
MARUTI SUZUKI as standard or
optional equipment for your vehicle.
Tire rotation
To avoid uneven wear of your tires and to
prolong their life, rotate the tires as illustrated. Tires should be rotated every 10000
km. After rotation, adjust front and rear tire
pressures to the specification listed on
your vehicle’s tire information label.
4-tire rotation
EXAMPLE
54G114
5-tire rotation
NOTICE
Replacing the original tires with tires
of a different size may result in false
speedometer or odometer readings.
Check with your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop before purchasing
replacement tires that differ in size
from the original tires.
EXAMPLE
68PH00755
7-20
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Battery
Replacement of the battery
EXAMPLE
(For petrol engine model)
WARNING
• Batteries
produce
flammable
hydrogen gas. Keep flames and
sparks away from the battery or an
explosion may occur. Never smoke
when working near the battery.
• When checking or servicing the
battery, disconnect the negative
cable. Be careful not to cause a
short circuit by allowing metal
objects to contact the battery posts
and the vehicle at the same time.
• To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump-starting instructions
in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE”
section if it is necessary to jumpstart your vehicle.
• Diluted sulfuric acid spilled from
battery can cause blindness or
severe burns. Use proper eye protection and gloves. Flush eyes or
body with ample water and get
medical care immediately if suffered. Keep batteries out of reach
of children.
EXAMPLE
MAX
(3)
(1)
(2)
MIN
(4)
54GM701
For maintenance-free battery (cap-less
type), you need not add water. For traditional type battery, which has water filler
caps, the level of the battery solution must
be kept between the “MAX” and the “MIN”
level lines at all times. If the level is found
to be below the “MIN” level line, add distilled water to the “MAX” level line. You
should periodically check the battery, battery terminals, and battery hold-down
bracket for corrosion. Remove corrosion
using a stiff brush and ammonia mixed
with water, or baking soda mixed with
water. After removing corrosion, rinse with
clean water.
If your vehicle is not going to be driven for
a month or longer, disconnect the cable
from the negative terminal of the battery to
help prevent discharge.
68PH00719
(For diesel engine model)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
EXAMPLE
66RM07002
7-21
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
To remove the battery:
1) Disconnect the negative cable (1).
2) Disconnect the positive cable (2).
For petrol engine model;
3) Remove the retainer nuts (3) and
remove the retainer (4).
For diesel engine model;
3) Remove the bracket bolt (3) and
remove the bracket (4).
4) Remove the battery.
To install the battery:
1) Install the battery in the reverse order of
removal.
2) Tighten the bracket bolt and battery
cables securely.
NOTE:
When the battery is disconnected, some of
the vehicle’s function will be initialized and/
or deactivated.
These function are required to reset after
the battery is reconnected.
WARNING
Batteries contain toxic substances
including sulfuric acid and lead. They
could have potential negative consequences for the environment and
human health. Used battery must be
disposed or recycled according to
the local law and must not be discarded with ordinary household
waste. Make sure not to tip over the
battery when you remove it from the
vehicle. Otherwise, sulfuric acid
could run out and you might get
injury.
Fuses
Your vehicle has three types of fuses, as
described below:
Main fuse
The main fuse takes current directly from
the battery.
Primary fuses
These fuses are between the main fuse
and individual fuses, and are for electrical
load groups.
Individual fuses
These fuses are for individual electrical circuits.
To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller provided in the fuse box.
EXAMPLE
63J095
7-22
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Fuses in engine compartment
MAIN FUSE / PRIMARY FUSE
EXAMPLE
(5)
(4)
(3)
(2)
(1)
66RH105
EXAMPLE
(15)
(16)
(17)
(24)
(36)
(2)
100 A
FL2
(3)
80 A
FL3
(4)
100 A
FL4
(5)
50 A
FL5
(6)
40 A
Power steering
(7)
5A
ECM
(8)
10 A
Air compressor
(9)
25 A
Headlight high
(10)
15 A
Headlight (Left)
(11)
15 A
Headlight (Right)
30 A
Starter motor
(9)
30 A*1
40 A*2
Radiator fan
(14)
–
(12)
(15)
40 A
(16)
–
(17)
30 A
T/M pump
(18)
30 A
Back-up
(10)
(18)
(11)
(26)
(19)
(27)
(20)
(28)
(21)
(13)
(29)
(22)
(14)
(31)
(35) (34) (33) (32)
FL1
(13)
(8)
(25)
(30)
120 A
(12)
(6)
(7)
(23)
(1)
FRONT
66RH106
(19)
–
(20)
15 A
Blank
Ignition switch 2
Blank
(21)
–
(22)
30 A
(23)
–
(24)
5A
(25)
–
(26)
15 A
Headlight high (Left)
(27)
15 A
Headlight high (Right)
(28)
20 A
INJ DRV
(29)
10 A
FI 2
(30)
15
A*1
30 A*2
Blank
Blower fan
Blank
Starting signal
Blank
FI
(31)
40 A
ABS motor
(32)
25 A
ABS solenoid
(33)
20 A
Fuel pump
(34)
10 A
T/M 2
(35)
5A
T/M 3
(36)
40 A
Ignition switch
*1: Petrol engine model
*2: Diesel engine model
Blank
Front fog light
7-23
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
The main fuse, primary fuses and some of
the individual fuses are located in the
engine compartment. If the main fuse
blows, no electrical component will function. If a primary fuse blows, no electrical
component in the corresponding load
group will function. When replacing the
main fuse, a primary fuse or an individual
fuse, use a genuine MARUTI replacement.
To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller provided in the fuse box. The amperage of
each fuse is shown in the back of the fuse
box cover.
EXAMPLE
Type A
WARNING
If the main fuse or a primary fuse
blows, have your vehicle inspected
by an authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop Always use a genuine MARUTI
replacement. Never use a substitute
such as a wire even for a temporary
repair, or extensive electrical damage
and a fire can result.
(11)
(12) (13)
(14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23)
NOTE:
Check that the fuse box always carries
spare fuses.
Fuses under dashboard
68PH00725
PRIMARY FUSE
EXAMPLE
OK
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10)
BLOWN
68PH00723
66RH084
(1)
10 A
Back-up light
(2)
15 A
Ignition coil
(3)
10 A
Meter
(4)
10 A
Wiper
(5)
5A
Ignition-2 signal
(6)
15 A
Washer
(7)
25 A
Front wiper
(8)
10 A
Tail light
(9)
10 A
Hazard
(10)
10 A
Stop light
(11)
30 A
Power window
7-24
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
(12)
15 A
ACC-2
(13)
5A
ACC
(14)
5A
Starting signal
(15)
10 A
Ignition-1 signal
(16)
10 A
Air bag
(17)
5A
ABS control module
(18)
15 A
Horn
(19)
20 A
Door lock
(20)
25 A
RR defogger
(21)
15 A
Radio
(22)
5A
Dome light
(23)
10 A
Dome light-2
PRIMARY FUSE
Type B
EXAMPLE
(1)
30 A
Power window
(2)
10 A
Meter
(3)
15 A
Ignition coil
(4)
5A
Ignition-1 signal 2
(5)
20 A
Shift
(6)
20 A
S/R
(7)
–
Blank
(8)
20 A
Door lock
(9)
15 A
Steering lock
(10)
10 A
Hazard
(11)
5A
A-STOP
(12)
10 A
Rear fog lamp
(13)
5A
ABS control module
(14)
15 A
S/H
(15)
5A
IG1 SIG3
(2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12)
(16)
10 A
Dome light-2
(13) (14) (15) (16) (17) (18) (19) (20) (21) (22) (23) (24) (25)
(17)
5A
Dome light
(26) (27) (28) (29) (30) (31) (32) (33) (34) (35) (36) (37) (38)
(18)
15 A
Radio
(19)
5A
Cont
(20)
5A
Key 2
(1)
(39)
(40)
(21)
20 A
P/W T
(22)
5A
Key
(23)
15 A
Horn
(24)
5A
Tail light (Left)
(25)
10 A
Tail light
(26)
10 A
Air bag
(27)
10 A
Ignition-1 signal
(28)
10 A
Back-up light
(29)
5A
ACC-3
(30)
20 A
Rear defogger
(31)
10 A
Heated mirror
(32)
15 A
ACC-2
(33)
5A
ACC
(34)
10 A
Wiper
(35)
5A
Ignition-2 signal
(36)
15 A
Washer
(37)
25 A
Front wiper
(38)
10 A
Stop light
(39)
–
(40)
25 A
Blank
Rear defogger
68PH00759
7-25
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Headlight aiming
EXAMPLE
Since special procedures are required, ask
your authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop
for this job.
Bulb replacement
CAUTION
OK
BLOWN
81A283
WARNING
Always replace a blown fuse with a
fuse of the correct amperage. Never
use a substitute such as aluminum
foil or wire to replace a blown fuse. If
you replace a fuse and the new one
blows in a short period of time, you
may have a major electrical problem.
Have your vehicle inspected immediately by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
• Light bulbs can be hot enough to
burn your finger right after turning
off lights. This is true especially for
halogen headlight bulbs. Replace
the bulbs after they become cool
enough.
• The halogen headlight bulbs are
filled with pressurized halogen gas.
They can burst and injure you if
they are hit or dropped. Handle
them carefully.
• To avoid injury by sharp-edged
parts of the body, wear gloves and
a long-sleeved shirt when replacing
light bulbs.
NOTICE
Frequent bulb replacement indicates
the need for an inspection of the electrical system. This should be carried
out by your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop.
Interior light
Remove the lens by using a flat-bladed
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as
shown. To install it, simply push it back in.
Front
EXAMPLE
NOTICE
• The oils from your skin may cause
a halogen bulb to overheat and
burst when the lights are on. Grasp
a new bulb with a clean cloth.
• During bulb replacement, always
use same bulb number as used in
the vehicle.
76MH0A139
7-26
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Luggage compartment (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Headlights
LED headlights (if equipped)
Since special procedures are required, we
recommend you take your vehicle to your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for
bulb replacement.
(3)
Halogen headlights (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
75RM068S
(1)
2) Push the retaining spring (3) forward
and unhook it. Then remove the bulb.
Install a new bulb in the reverse order
of removal.
81PN162
Courtesy light (if equipped)
(2)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RH151
1) Open the engine hood. Disconnect the
coupler (1). Remove the sealing rubber
(2).
(4)
EXAMPLE
66RH140
75RM069
NOTE:
You can see the position of retaining spring
from the hole (4) of headlight.
7-27
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Front fog light (if equipped)
1) Start the engine. Turn the steering
wheel to the opposite side of the fog
light to be replaced to replace the bulb
easily. Then turn off the engine.
EXAMPLE
Other general lights
Bulb holder
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
(2)
68PH00736
3) Open the end of the cover inside the
fender. Disconnect the coupler by pushing the lock release. Turn the bulb
holder counterclockwise and remove it.
(1)
75RM094
2) Remove the clip (1) by prying it off with
a flat-bladed screwdriver as shown in
the illustration.
(1)
54G123
(1) Removal
(2) Installation
To remove a bulb holder from a light housing, turn the holder counterclockwise and
pull it out. To install the holder, push the
holder in and turn it clockwise.
7-28
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Front turn signal light (1)
Front position light (2)
Bulb
EXAMPLE
Side turn signal light (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Models with halogen headlights
EXAMPLE
(1)
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)
54G124
68PH00729
(3) Removal
(4) Installation
There are two types of bulb, full glass type
(1) and glass/metal type (2).
To remove and install a full glass type bulb
(1), simply pull out or push in the bulb.
75RM066
Models with LED headlights
1) Remove the light housing (1) by sliding
to left with your finger.
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(2)
(1)
To remove a glass metal type bulb (2) from
a bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it
counterclockwise. To install a new bulb,
push it in and turn it clockwise.
You can access the individual bulb or bulb
holders as follows.
68PH00760
62R0306
2) Turn the bulb holder (2) clockwise and
pull it out from the light housing.
7-29
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Rear combination light
Reversing light
EXAMPLE
(3)
(3)
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
75RM070
62R0122
Remove the bolts (1) and pull the light
housing (2) straight.
1) Open the tailgate and remove the trim
(1) of the tailgate.
• Insert a flat blade screwdriver covered with a soft cloth between the trim
and the tailgate to make a space for
fingers, and then pull out the trim with
your fingers.
NOTE:
When reinstalling the light housing, check
that the clips (3) are properly attached.
62R0378
2) Disconnect the coupler (2) by pushing
the lock release. Turn the bulb holder of
the reversing light (3) counterclockwise
and remove it.
7-30
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Wiper blades
License plate light
NOTE:
Some wiper blades may be different from
the ones described here depending on
vehicle specifications. If so, consult your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for
proper replacement method.
EXAMPLE
For windshield wipers:
EXAMPLE
75RM071
EXAMPLE
54G129
If the wiper blades become brittle or damaged, or make streaks when wiping,
replace the wiper blades.
To install new wiper blades, follow the procedures below.
NOTICE
To avoid scratching or breaking the
window, do not let the wiper arm
strike the window while replacing the
wiper blade.
70G119
1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window.
NOTE:
When raising both of the front wiper arms,
pull the driver’s side wiper arm up first.
When returning the wiper arms, lower the
passenger’s side wiper arm first.
Otherwise, the wiper arms may interfere
with each other.
7-31
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Removal
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(4)
(2)
(1)
(4)
EXAMPLE
68PH00751
Installation
(3)
(2)
EXAMPLE
68PH00753
(4) Retainer
4) If the new blade is provided without the
two metal retainers (4), move them
from the old blade to the new one.
EXAMPLE
(3)
(1)
(4)
68PH00750
2) Squeeze lock (1) towards wiper arm (2)
and remove the wiper frame from the
arm as shown.
3) Unlock the lock end of the wiper blade
and slide the blade out as shown.
68PH00752
(4)
(3) Locked end
68PH00754
7-32
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
For rear wipers:
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
(A)
(B)
(4)
EXAMPLE
60MHM7001
68PH00764
(A) Up
(B) Down
NOTE:
Do not flex the wiper blade frame end more
than necessary. If you do, it can break off.
NOTE:
When you install the metal retainers (4),
check that the direction of metal retainers
is as shown in the above illustrations.
5) Install the new blade in the reverse
order of removal, with the locked end
positioned toward the wiper arm.
Check that the blade is properly
retained by all the hooks. Lock the
blade end into place.
6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm, checking
that the lock lever is snapped securely
into the arm.
68PH00763
1) Hold the wiper arm away from the window.
2) Remove the wiper frame from the arm
as shown.
3) Slide the blade out as shown.
7-33
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
Windshield washer fluid
EXAMPLE
Air conditioning system
EXAMPLE
(1)
(1)
Replacement of the Air Conditioner
Filter (if equipped)
68PH00765
(1) Retainer
4) If the new blade is provided without the
two metal retainers, move them from
the old blade to the new one.
5) Install the new blade in the reverse
order of removal.
Check that the blade is properly
retained by all the hooks.
6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm in the
reverse order of removal.
If you do not use the air conditioner for a
long period, such as during winter, it may
not give the best performance when you
start using it again. To help maintain optimum performance and durability of your air
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.
Operate the air conditioner at least once a
month for one minute with the engine
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil
and helps protect the internal components.
68PH00756
Check that there is washer fluid in the tank.
Refill it if necessary. Use a good quality
windshield washer fluid, diluted with water
as necessary.
Since special procedures are required, we
recommend you take your vehicle to your
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop for the
air conditioner filter replacement.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Do not use anti-freeze solution in the
windshield washer reservoir. This
can severely impair visibility when
sprayed on the windshield, and also
damage your vehicle’s paint.
NOTICE
Damage may result if the washer
motor is operated with no fluid in the
washer tank.
66RM07003
7-34
66RH0-74E
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE
1) To approach the air conditioner filter,
press inward on both sides of the glove
box, pull it frontward and remove it.
(3)
(1)
(2)
EXAMPLE
66RM07004
2) Remove the cover (1) and pull out the
air conditioner filter (2).
NOTE:
When you install a new filter, make sure
the UP mark (3) faces upward.
7-35
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Tire changing tool ............................................................... 8-1
Jacking instructions ........................................................... 8-2
Jump-starting instructions ................................................. 8-6
Towing .................................................................................. 8-8
Engine trouble: Starter does not operate ......................... 8-9
Engine trouble: Flooded engine ........................................ 8-9
Engine trouble: Overheating .............................................. 8-9
Warning Triangle ................................................................. 8-11
8
60G411
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Tire changing tool
WARNING
EXAMPLE
After using the tire changing tools,
stow them securely or they can
cause injury if an accident occurs.
CAUTION
The jack should be used only to
change wheels. It is important to read
the jacking instructions in this section before attempting to use the
jack.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
EXAMPLE
66RH157
66RM08003
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
Jack
Wheel brace
Jack handle
Towing hook
The tire changing tools are stowed in the luggage compartment below the spare tire.
To remove the luggage compartment
board easily, fold the right side of the board
and pull it out.
NOTE:
When installing, install the board in the
reverse order of removal.
8-1
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Jacking instructions
EXAMPLE
(5)
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
66RM08004
66RM08002
75F062
To remove the spare tire, turn its holder
bolt (5) counterclockwise and remove it.
Hold and lift the spare tire as shown in
above illustration for easy removal of spare
tire. Install spare tire in the reverse order of
removal.
1) Place the vehicle on level, hard ground.
2) Set the parking brake firmly and shift
into “R” (Reverse) if your vehicle has a
manual transaxle/Auto Gear Shift.
EXAMPLE
While replacing tire with alloy wheel (if
equipped) make sure to remove the wheel
cap before keeping the tire in the trunk.
NOTICE
Be sure that spare tire does not move
after tightening the holder bolt.
66RM08001
WARNING
• Shift into “R” (Reverse) for a manual
transaxle/Auto Gear Shift vehicle
when you jack up the vehicle.
• Never jack up the vehicle with the
transaxle in “N” (Neutral). Otherwise, unstable jack may cause an
accident.
3) Turn on the hazard warning flasher if
your vehicle is near traffic.
4) Block the front and rear of the wheel
diagonally opposite of the wheel being
lifted.
8-2
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
5) Place the spare wheel near the wheel
being lifted as shown in the illustration
in case the jack slips.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
EXAMPLE
75RM078
66RM08006
EXAMPLE
6) Position the jack at an angle as shown
in the illustration and raise the jack by
turning the jack handle clockwise until
the jack-head groove fits around the
jacking bar beneath the vehicle body.
7) Continue to raise the jack slowly and
smoothly until the tire clears the
ground. Do not raise the vehicle more
than necessary.
• Use the jack only to change wheels
on level, hard ground.
• Never jack up the vehicle on an
inclined surface.
• Never raise the vehicle with the
jack in a location other than the
specified jacking point (shown in
the illustration) near the wheel to
be changed.
• Check that the jack is raised at
least 25 mm (1 inch) before it contacts the flange. Use of the jack
when it is within 25 mm (1 inch) of
being fully collapsed may result in
failure of the jack.
• Never get under the vehicle when it
is supported by the jack.
• Never run the engine when the
vehicle is supported by the jack
and never allow passengers to
remain in the vehicle.
Raising vehicle with garage jack
• Apply the garage jack to one of the
points indicated below.
• Always support the raised vehicle with
jack stands (commercially available) at
the points indicated below.
75RM077
8-3
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
EXAMPLE
NOTICE
Front
(2)
(1)
Rear
Never apply a garage jack to the
exhaust pipe, side under spoiler (if
equipped), engine undercover or rear
torsion beam.
(2)
(1)
Front
NOTE:
For more details, contact an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
Rear
(4)
(4)
(3)
(3)
66RM08005S
(1) Jack stand
(2) Jacking point for jack stand
(3) Garage jack
(4) Jacking point for garage jack
8-4
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Changing wheels
4) Remove the wheel nuts and wheel.
To change a wheel, use the following procedure:
(1)
1) Remove the jack, tools and spare
wheel from the vehicle.
2) Loosen, but do not remove the wheel
nuts.
3) Jack up the vehicle (follow the jacking
instructions in this section).
WARNING
EXAMPLE
• Shift into “R” (Reverse) for a manual
transaxle/Auto Gear Shift vehicle
when you jack up the vehicle.
• Never jack up the vehicle with the
transaxle in “N” (Neutral). Otherwise, unstable jack may cause an
accident.
54G116
Tightening torque for wheel nut
85 Nm (8.7 kg-m, 62.7 lb-ft)
(2)
7) Lower the jack and fully tighten the nuts
with a wrench in numerical order as
shown in the illustration.
(3)
EXAMPLE
WARNING
(4)
65J4033
5) Clean any mud or dirt off from the surface of the wheel (1), hub (2), thread
part (3) and surface of the wheel nuts
(4) with a clean cloth. Clean the hub
carefully; it may be hot from driving.
6) Install the new wheel and replace the
wheel nuts with their cone shaped end
facing the wheel. Tighten each nut
snugly by hand until the wheel is
securely seated on the hub.
Use genuine wheel nuts and tighten
them to the specified torque as soon
as possible after changing wheels.
Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly
tightened wheel nuts may come
loose or fall off, which can result in
an accident. If you do not have a
torque wrench, have the wheel nut
torque checked by an authorised
Maruti Suzuki workshop.
8-5
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Full wheel cover (if equipped)
EXAMPLE
Jump-starting instructions
EXAMPLE
(1)
WARNING
(2)
54P000803
60G309
(1) or (2) Flat end tool
Your vehicle includes two tools, a wheel
brace and a jack crank, one of which has a
flat end.
Use the tool with the flat end to remove the
full wheel cap, as shown above.
Install the full wheel cover not to cover or
foul the air valve.
• Never attempt to jump-start your
vehicle if the battery appears to be
frozen. Batteries in this condition
may explode.
• When making jump lead connections, check that your hands and
the jump leads remain clear from
pulleys, belts or fans.
• Batteries
produce
flammable
hydrogen gas. Keep flames and
sparks away from the battery or an
explosion may occur. Never smoke
when working near the battery.
• If the booster battery you use for
jump-starting is installed in another
vehicle, check that the two vehicles
are not touching each other.
• If your battery discharges repeatedly, for no apparent reason, have
your vehicle inspected by an
authorised Maruti Suzuki workshop.
• To avoid harm to yourself or damage to your vehicle or battery, follow the jump-starting instructions
below.
If you are in doubt, call for qualified
road service.
8-6
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
NOTICE
WARNING
Your vehicle should not be started by
pushing or towing. This starting
method could result in permanent
damage to the catalytic converter.
Use jump leads to start a vehicle with
a weak or flat battery.
1) Use only a 12-volt battery to jump-start
your vehicle. Position the good 12-volt
battery close to your vehicle so that the
jump leads will reach both batteries.
When using a battery installed on
another vehicle, check that two vehicles
do not touch each other. Set the parking brakes fully on both vehicles.
2) Turn off all vehicle accessories, except
those necessary for safety reasons (for
example, headlights or hazard lights).
Never connect the jump lead directly
to the negative (–) terminal of the discharged battery, or an explosion may
occur.
(1)
CAUTION
(3)
EXAMPLE
(2)
54P000804
3) Connect jump leads as follows:
1. Connect one end of the first jump
lead to the positive (+) terminal of
the flat battery (1).
2. Connect the other end to the positive
(+) terminal of the booster battery
(2).
3. Connect one end of the second jump
lead to the negative (–) terminal of
the booster battery (2).
4. Make the final connection to an
unpainted, heavy metal part (i.e.
engine mount bracket (3)) of the
engine of the vehicle with the flat
battery (1).
Connect the jump lead to the engine
mount bracket securely. If the jump
lead disconnects from the engine
mount bracket because of vibration
at the start of the engine, the jump
lead could be caught in the drive
belts.
4) If the booster battery you are using is
fitted to another vehicle, start the
engine of the vehicle with the booster
battery. Run the engine at moderate
speed.
5) Start the engine of the vehicle with the
flat battery.
6) Remove the jump leads in the exact
reverse order in which you connected
them.
8-7
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Towing
If you need to have your vehicle towed,
contact a professional service. Your dealer
can provide you with detailed towing
instructions.
NOTICE
Observe the following instructions
when towing your vehicle.
• To help avoid damage to your vehicle during towing, proper equipment and towing procedures must
be used.
• Using the frame hook, tow your
vehicle on paved roads for short
distances at low speed.
2-wheel drive (2WD) manual
transaxle or Auto Gear Shift
Manual transaxle vehicles or Auto Gear
Shift vehicles may be towed using either of
the following methods.
1) From the front, with the front wheels
lifted and the rear wheels on the
ground. Before towing, check that the
parking brake is released.
2) From the rear, with the rear wheels
lifted and the front wheels on the
ground, provided the steering and
drivetrain are in operational condition.
Before towing, check that transaxle is in
neutral, the steering wheel is unlocked
(vehicle without keyless push start system - the ignition key should be in
“ACC” position) (vehicle with keyless
push start system - the ignition mode is
ACC), and the steering wheel is
secured with a clamping device
designed for towing service.
NOTICE
NOTICE
After shifting the Auto Gear Shift
gearshift lever to the “N” position,
always check the gear position indicator in the instrument cluster shows
the “N” position to make sure that the
transaxle is disengaged.
If the transaxle cannot be put in neutral, turn the key from the “LOCK” to
the “ON” position or press the engine
switch to change the ignition mode to
ON, and move the Auto Gear Shift
gearshift lever from “N” to “D”, “M”
or “R”, then back to “N” again. Then
turn the key from the “ON” to the
“LOCK” position or press the engine
switch to change the ignition mode to
LOCK (OFF). These procedures may
help put the transaxle in neutral. If
the transaxle still cannot be put in
neutral, you cannot tow the vehicle
without using a towing dolly.
The steering column is not strong
enough to withstand shocks transmitted from the front wheels during
towing. Always unlock the steering
wheel before towing.
8-8
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Engine trouble:
Starter does not operate
Engine trouble: Flooded
engine
1) Try turning the ignition switch to
“START” position or try pressing the
engine switch to change the ignition
mode to START with the headlights
turned on to determine the battery condition. If the headlights go excessively
dim or go off, it usually means that
either the battery is flat or the battery
terminal contact is poor. Recharge the
battery or correct battery terminal contact as necessary.
2) If the headlights remain bright, check
the fuses. If the reason for failure of the
starter is not obvious, there may be a
major electrical problem. Have the vehicle inspected by your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
If the engine is flooded with fuel, it may be
hard to start. If this happens, press the
accelerator pedal all the way to the floor
and hold it there while cranking the engine.
• For petrol engine model, do not operate
the starter motor for more than 12 seconds.
• For diesel engine model, do not operate
the starter motor for more than 30 seconds.
NOTE:
For keyless push start, if the engine
refuses to start, the starter motor automatically stops after a certain period of time.
After the starter motor has automatically
stopped or if there is anything abnormal in
the engine starting system, the starter
motor runs only while the engine switch is
held pressed.
Engine trouble: Overheating
The engine could overheat temporarily
under severe driving conditions. If the high
engine coolant temperature warning light
comes on as overheating during driving:
1) Turn off the air conditioner, if equipped.
2) Take the vehicle to a safe place and
park.
3) Let the engine run at the normal idle
speed for a few minutes until the high
engine coolant temperature warning
light goes off.
WARNING
If you see or hear escaping steam,
stop the vehicle in a safe place and
immediately turn off the engine to
cool it. Do not open the hood when
steam is present. When the steam
can no longer be seen or heard, open
the hood to see if the coolant is still
boiling. If it is, you must wait until it
stops boiling before you proceed.
8-9
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
If the high engine coolant temperature
warning light does not go off:
WARNING
1) Turn off the engine and check that the
water pump belt and pulleys are not
damaged or slipping. If any abnormality
is found, correct it.
2) Check the coolant level in the reservoir.
If it is found to be lower than “LOW”
line, check radiator, water pump, radiator hoses and heater hoses for leakage.
If leakage that may cause overheating
is found, do not run the engine until
these problems have been corrected.
3) If leakage is not found, carefully add
coolant to the reservoir and then the
radiator, if necessary. (Refer to “Engine
coolant” in the “INSPECTION AND
MAINTENANCE” section).
EXAMPLE
79J007
• It is hazardous to remove the radiator cap (or degassing tank cap for a
diesel engine) when the water temperature is high, because scalding
fluid and steam may be blown out
under pressure. The cap should
only be taken off when the coolant
temperature has lowered.
• To help prevent personal injury,
keep hands, tools and clothing
away from the engine cooling fan
and
air-conditioner
fan
(if
equipped). These electric fans can
automatically turn on without warning.
NOTE:
If engine overheats and you are not sure
what to do, contact your authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
EXAMPLE
65D350D
8-10
66RH0-74E
EMERGENCY SERVICE
Warning Triangle
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
EXAMPLE
MH007001
In case of vehicle break-down or during
emergency stopping, where, your vehicle
could become a potential traffic hazard,
keep the warning triangle, provided with
your vehicle, on the road free from any
obstacles behind your vehicle so as to
warn the approaching traffic, at an approximate distance of 50-100 m. The reflecting
side of the triangle should face the on coming traffic. Please activate the hazard
warning lamps before alighting the vehicle
to keep the warning triangle.
MH007014
MH007015
• Remove the warning triangle carefully
from the cover as shown by arrow 1.
• Open both the reflector arms as shown
by arrow and lock the arms with each
other with the clip provided in the right
arm. Open the bottom stand in counter
clock-wise direction as shown by arrow
3. Position the warning triangle behind
the vehicle on a plain surface.
• Reverse the removal procedure for
keeping inside the cover.
8-11
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
APPEARANCE CARE
Corrosion prevention .......................................................... 9-1
Vehicle cleaning .................................................................. 9-2
60G412
9
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
Corrosion prevention
It is important to take good care of your
vehicle to protect it from corrosion. Listed
below are instructions for how to maintain
your vehicle to prevent corrosion. Please
read and follow these instructions carefully.
This information illustrates the necessity of
keeping your vehicle (particularly the
underbody) as clean and dry as possible. It
is equally important to repair any damage
to the paint or protective coatings as soon
as possible.
Important information about corrosion
How to help prevent corrosion
Common causes of corrosion
1) Accumulation of road salt, dirt, moisture
or chemicals in hard-to-reach areas of
the vehicle underbody or frame.
2) Chipping, scratches and any damage to
treated or painted metal surfaces
resulting from minor accidents or abrasion by stones and gravel.
Environmental conditions which accelerate corrosion
1) Road salt, dust control chemicals, sea
air or industrial pollution will all accelerate the corrosion of metal.
2) High humidity will increase the rate of
corrosion particularly when the temperature range is just above the freezing point.
3) Moisture in certain areas of a vehicle
for an extended period of time may promote corrosion even though other body
sections may be completely dry.
4) High temperatures will cause an accelerated rate of corrosion to parts of the
vehicle which are not well-ventilated to
permit quick drying.
Wash your vehicle frequently
The best way to preserve the finish on your
vehicle and to help avoid corrosion is to
keep it clean with frequent washing.
Wash your vehicle at least once during the
winter and once immediately after the winter. Keep your vehicle, particularly the
underside, as clean and dry as possible.
If you frequently drive on salted roads,
your vehicle should be washed at least
once a month during the winter. If you live
near the ocean, your vehicle should be
washed at least once a month throughout
the year.
For washing instructions, refer to “Vehicle
cleaning” section.
Remove foreign material deposits
Foreign material such as salts, chemicals,
road oil or tar, tree sap, bird droppings and
industrial fall-out may damage the finish of
your vehicle if it is left on painted surfaces.
Remove these types of deposits as quickly
as possible. If these deposits are difficult to
wash off, an additional cleaner may be
required. Check that any cleaner you use
is not harmful to painted surfaces and is
specifically intended for your purposes.
Follow the manufacturer’s directions when
using these special cleaners.
Repair finish damage
Carefully examine your vehicle for damage
to the painted surfaces. Should you find
any chips or scratches in the paint, touch
them up immediately to prevent corrosion
from starting. If the chips or scratches have
gone through to the bare metal, have a
qualified body shop make the repair.
Keep passenger and luggage compartments clean
Moisture, dirt or mud can accumulate
under the floor mats and may cause corrosion. Occasionally, check under these
mats to ensure that this area is clean and
dry. More frequent checks are necessary if
the vehicle is used for off-road driving or in
wet weather.
Certain cargos such as chemicals, fertilizers, cleaners, salts, etc. are extremely corrosive by nature. These products should
be transported in sealed containers. If they
9-1
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
are spilled or leaked, clean and dry the
area immediately.
Vehicle cleaning
Cleaning interior
Vinyl upholstery
Prepare a solution of soap or mild detergent mixed with warm water. Apply the
solution to the vinyl with a sponge or soft
cloth and let it soak for a few minutes to
loosen dirt.
Rub the surface with a clean, damp cloth
to remove dirt and the soap solution. If
some dirt still remains on the surface,
repeat this procedure.
Store your vehicle in a dry, well-ventilated area
Do not park your vehicle in a damp, poorlyventilated area. If you often wash your
vehicle in the garage and place it there in
wet condition, your garage may be damp.
The high humidity in the garage may
cause or accelerate corrosion. A wet vehicle may corrode even in a heated garage if
the ventilation is poor.
EXAMPLE
WARNING
Do not apply additional undercoating
or rust preventive coating on or
around exhaust system components
such as the catalytic converter and
exhaust pipes. A fire could be started
if the undercoating substance
becomes overheated.
76G044S
WARNING
When cleaning the interior or exterior
of the vehicle, do not use flammable
solvents such as lacquer thinners,
petrol and benzene. Also, do not use
cleaning materials such as bleaches
and strong household detergents.
The materials could cause personal
injury or damage to the vehicle.
Fabric upholstery
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Using a mild soap solution, rub stained
areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove
soap, rub the areas again with a cloth
dampened with water. Repeat this until the
stain is removed, or use a commercial fabric cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a
fabric cleaner, carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions.
9-2
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
Leather upholstery
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Using a mild soap or saddle soap solution,
wipe dirt off with a clean damp soft cloth.
To remove soap, wipe the areas again with
a soft cloth dampened with water. Wipe the
areas dry with a soft dry cloth. Repeat this
until the dirt or stain is removed, or use a
commercial leather cleaner for tougher dirt
or stains. If you use a leather cleaner,
carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions. Do not use solvent
type cleaners or abrasive cleaners.
NOTE:
• In order to keep leather upholstery looking good, it should be cleaned at least
twice a year.
• If leather upholstery becomes wet,
immediately wipe it dry with tissue paper
or a soft cloth. Water may cause leather
to harden and shrink if it is not wiped off.
• When parking on sunny days, select a
shady place or use a sunshade. If
leather upholstery is exposed to direct
sunlight for a long time, it may discolor
and shrink.
• As is common with natural materials,
leather is inherently irregular in grain and
cowhide has spots in its natural state.
These do not affect the performance of
the leather in any way.
Seat belts
Clean seat belts with a mild soap and
water. Do not use bleach or dye on the
belts. They may weaken the fabric in the
belts.
Vinyl floor mats
Ordinary dirt can be removed from vinyl
with water or mild soap. Use a brush to
help loosen dirt. After the dirt is loosened,
rinse the mat thoroughly with water and
dry it in the shade.
Carpets
Remove dirt and soil as much as possible
with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap
solution, rub stained areas with a clean
damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas
again with a cloth dampened with water.
Repeat this until the stain is removed, or
use a commercial carpet cleaner for
tougher stains. If you use a carpet cleaner,
carefully follow the manufacturer’s instructions and precautions.
Instrument panel and console
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.
Gently wipe dirt off with a tightly squeezed
damp clean cloth. Repeat this until the dirt
is removed.
NOTICE
Do not use chemical products that
contain silicon to wipe electrical
components such as the air conditioning system, audio, navigation
system, or other switches. These will
cause damage to the components.
Cleaning exterior
NOTICE
It is important that your vehicle be
kept clean and free from dirt. Failure
to keep your vehicle clean may result
in fading of the paint or corrosion to
various parts of the vehicle body.
Caring for aluminum wheels
NOTE:
• Do not use an acidic or alkaline detergent, or a cleaner containing petroleum
solvent to wash aluminum wheels.
These types of cleaner will cause permanent spots, discoloration and cracks
on finished surfaces and damage to center caps.
• Do not use a bristle brush and soap containing an abrasive material. These will
damage finished surfaces.
9-3
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
Washing
WARNING
• Never attempt to wash and wax
your vehicle with the engine running.
• When cleaning the underside of the
body and fender, where there may
be sharp-edged parts, wear gloves
and a long-sleeved shirt to protect
your hands and arms from being
cut.
• After washing your vehicle, carefully test the brakes before driving
to check that they have maintained
their normal effectiveness.
When washing the vehicle, park it in the
place where direct sunlight does not fall on
it and follow the instructions below:
1) Flush the underside of body and wheel
housings with pressurized water to
remove mud and debris. Use plenty of
water.
3) Wash the entire exterior with a mild
detergent or car wash soap using a
sponge or soft cloth. The sponge or
cloth should be frequently soaked in the
soap solution.
NOTICE
When using a commercial car wash
product, observe the cautions specified by the manufacturer. Never use
strong household detergents or
soaps.
When washing the vehicle:
• Avoid directing steam or hot water
of more than 80°C (176°F) on plastic parts.
• To avoid damaging engine components, do not use pressurized
water in the engine compartment.
2) Rinse the body to loosen the dirt.
Remove dirt and mud from the body
exterior with running water. You may
use a soft sponge or brush. Do not use
hard materials which can scratch the
paint or plastic. Remember that the
headlight covers or lenses are made of
plastic in many cases.
Washing by hand
EXAMPLE
NOTICE
To avoid damage to the paint or plastic surface, do not wipe the dirt off
without ample water. Follow the
above procedure.
NOTICE
4) Once the dirt has been completely
removed, rinse off the detergent with
running water.
5) Wipe off the vehicle body with a wet
chamois or cloth and allow it to dry in
the shade.
6) Check carefully for damage to painted
surfaces. If there is any damage, touch
up the damage following the procedure
below:
1. Clean all damaged spots and allow
them to dry.
2. Stir the paint and touch up the damaged spots lightly using a small
brush.
3. Allow the paint to dry completely.
60B212S
9-4
66RH0-74E
APPEARANCE CARE
Washing by an automatic car wash
NOTICE
Waxing
EXAMPLE
If you use an automatic car wash,
check that your vehicle’s body parts,
such as spoilers, cannot be damaged. If you are in doubt, consult the
car wash operator for advice.
Washing by a high-pressure cleaner
NOTICE
If you use a high-pressure cleaner,
keep away the nozzle from your vehicle sufficiently.
• Bringing the nozzle to your vehicle
too close or pointing the nozzle to
the opening of front grill or bumper
etc. can cause damage and malfunction of the vehicle body and
parts.
• Pointing the nozzle to the weatherstrip of door glasses, doors and the
sunroof (if equipped) can allow
water to enter the cabin.
60B211S
After washing the vehicle, waxing and polishing are recommended to further protect
and beautify the paint.
• Only use waxes and polishes of good
quality.
• When using waxes and polishes,
observe the precautions specified by the
manufacturers.
9-5
66RH0-74E
GENERAL INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION
Vehicle identification .......................................................... 10-1
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) Tag ...................... 10-1
84MM01001
10
66RH0-74E
GENERAL INFORMATION
Vehicle identification
also used to assist your dealer when
ordering or referring to special service
information. Whenever you have occasion
to consult your authorised Maruti Suzuki
workshop, remember to identify your vehicle with this number. Should you find the
number difficult to read, you will also find it
on the identification plate.
Chassis serial number
EXAMPLE
Engine serial number
EXAMPLE
Radio frequency
identification (RFID) tag
As per Ministry of Road Transport and
Highways, the Radio frequency identification (RFID) tag (1) is mandatory for each
vehicle for the purpose of electronic toll
collection or any other purpose as may be
defined by the Government of India.
In case of any damage to RFID tag or
replacement of front windscreen, please
contact your nearest authorised Maruti
Suzuki workshop.
EXAMPLE
74LHT1001
EXAMPLE
60G128
The engine serial number is stamped on
the cylinder block as shown in the illustration.
(1)
68MH1001
66RH153
The chassis and/or engine serial numbers
are used to register the vehicle. They are
10-1
66RH0-74E
GENERAL INFORMATION
As seen from inside of the vehicle
EXAMPLE
68MH1002
NOTE:
The picture shown is for indicative purpose
only. Internal structure of actual device
mounted on vehicle may be different.
As seen from outside of the vehicle
EXAMPLE
68MH1003
NOTE:
The picture shown is for indicative purpose
only. Internal structure of actual device
mounted on vehicle may be different.
NOTE:
• RFID tag needs to be registered by government authorised agency (if applicable).
• Any attempt to remove the tag from the
windscreen will result in permanent damage to the tag.
• Use of chemical cleaners to clean the
windscreen area where the tag is
mounted can damage the tag.
• Use of any sharp objects on the tag can
damage the tag.
10-2
66RH0-74E
SPECIFICATIONS
SPECIFICATIONS
NOTE:
Specifications are subject to change without notice.
M/T: Manual transaxle
Petrol: Petrol (K12M) engine model
Diesel: Diesel (D13A) engine model
ITEM: Dimensions
Overall length
Overall width
Overall height
Wheelbase
UNIT: mm
3700
1660 – 1690
1595
2435
1460
1470
180
Front
Rear
Ground clearance (Unladen condition)
Track
ITEM: Mass (weight)
Curb mass (weight)
UNIT: kg
Diesel
M/T
825 – 860
940 – 960
Auto Gear Shift
850 – 860
950 – 960
Gross vehicle mass (weight) rating
Permissible maximum axle weight
Petrol
1280
1380
Front
660
760
Rear
680
680
11
11-1
66RH0-74E
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Engine
Type
Number of cylinders
K12M (DOHC)
D13A (DOHC)
4
4
Bore
73.0 mm
69.6 mm
Stroke
71.5 mm
82.0 mm
Piston displacement
1197 cm3
1248 cm3
11.0 : 1
17.6 : 1
Compression ratio
ITEM: Electrical
Standard spark plug
Battery
Fuses
Petrol
NGK LKR6F-10
Petrol
12V 34B19L
Diesel
12V DIN50L
See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
11-2
66RH0-74E
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Lights
Headlight
Halogen headlight
LED headlight
Front fog light (if equipped)
Position light
WATTAGE
BULB No.
12V 60/55W
H4
LED
–
12V 19W
H16
12V 5W
W5W
LED
–
LED
–
Front
12V 21W
WY21W
Rear
12V 21W
PY21W
12V 5W
WY5W
LED
–
12V 21/5W
P21/5W
LED
–
Reversing light
12V 16W
W16W
License plate light
12V 5W
W5W
Front
12V 10W
–
Luggage compartment
(if equipped)
12V 5W
W5W
Courtesy light
(if equipped)
12V 5W
W5W
Daytime running light (if equipped)
Turn signal light
Side turn signal light
Tail/brake light
High mount stop light
Interior light
11-3
66RH0-74E
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Wheels and tires
Tire size, front and rear
Rim size
Tire pressures
Recommended snow tire
Tire size, spare*3
175/65R15 84H*1
15X5J
For the specified tire pressure, see the tire information label on the
driver’s door lock pillar.
175/65R15 84H*2
175/65R15 84H
*1 If you cannot prepare tires with the specified load index rating and speed symbol, prepare tires with higher load index rate and speed
symbol.
*2 If you prepare snow tires;
• Check that they are tires of the same size, structure and load capacity as the originally installed tires.
• Mount the snow tires on all four wheels.
• Understand that the maximum permissible speed of snow tires is generally less than the originally installed tires.
*3 The spare wheel provided with alloy wheel variant is of steel wheel rim, hence follow 4 tire rotation only (Refer: Section Inspection
and Maintenance).
11-4
66RH0-74E
SPECIFICATIONS
ITEM: Recommended fuel / lubricants and capacities (approx.)
Fuel
See “FUEL RECOMMENDATION” section.
32 L
Petrol
Classification: API SL, SM or SN
Viscosity: SAE 0W-20
3.1 L
(replacement with oil filter)
Diesel
Classification: ACEA A5/B5
Viscosity: SAE 5W-30
3.1 L
(replacement with oil filter)
Engine oil
3.8 L
(including reservoir tank)
M/T
Petrol
Engine coolant
Auto Gear
Shift
M/T
Diesel
Manual transaxle oil/
Auto Gear Shift oil
Brake fluid / Clutch fluid
Petrol
Diesel
See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”
section.
Auto Gear
Shift
3.8 L
(including reservoir tank)
5.6 L
(including degassing tank)
5.6 L
(including degassing tank)
MARUTI GENUINE GEAR OIL 75W-80
MARUTI GENUINE BRAKE FLUID (MGBF)
or DOT 3
1.5 L
2.6 L
Refill to the proper oil level according
to the instructions in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” section.
11-5
66RH0-74E
This Owner Manual & Service Booklet applies to the IGNIS series
produced by MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
January, 2017
Part No. 99011M66R00-74E
For 24 X 7 assistance, contact Toll Free number 1800 200 6392#
© COPYRIGHT MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED 2017
Note: The illustrated model is one of the IGNIS Series.
(NEXA)
CODE 01/01/17/2000
99011M66R00-74E
Service Division
MARUTI SUZUKI INDIA LIMITED
Palam Gurgaon Road, Gurgaon - 122 015 (Haryana)
www.marutisuzuki.com
OWNER’S MANUAL & SERVICE BOOKLET
• Keep With Vehicle At All Times • Contains Important Information On Safety, Operation & Maintenance
Part No. 99011M66R00-74E
January, 2017
ENG